blob: f8c29b24172578937564273754ad0cba5c9d2a12 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau2e077f82019-11-25 20:36:16 +01005 version 2.2
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau1385c882020-06-11 10:22:10 +02007 2020/06/11
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200543.7. Programs
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +0100553.8. HTTP-errors
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +0200563.9. Rings
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020057
584. Proxies
594.1. Proxy keywords matrix
604.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
61
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100625. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200635.1. Bind options
645.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200655.3. Server DNS resolution
665.3.1. Global overview
675.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020068
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100696. Cache
706.1. Limitation
716.2. Setup
726.2.1. Cache section
736.2.2. Proxy section
74
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200757. Using ACLs and fetching samples
767.1. ACL basics
777.1.1. Matching booleans
787.1.2. Matching integers
797.1.3. Matching strings
807.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
817.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
827.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
837.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
847.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200857.3.1. Converters
867.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
877.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
887.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
897.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
907.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200917.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200927.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020093
948. Logging
958.1. Log levels
968.2. Log formats
978.2.1. Default log format
988.2.2. TCP log format
998.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01001008.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +01001018.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001028.3. Advanced logging options
1038.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1048.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1058.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1068.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1078.4. Timing events
1088.5. Session state at disconnection
1098.6. Non-printable characters
1108.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1118.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1128.9. Examples of logs
113
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001149. Supported filters
1159.1. Trace
1169.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001179.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001189.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001199.5. fcgi-app
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200120
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012110. FastCGI applications
12210.1. Setup
12310.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12410.1.2. Proxy section
12510.1.3. Example
12610.2. Default parameters
12710.3. Limitations
128
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200129
1301. Quick reminder about HTTP
131----------------------------
132
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100133When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200134fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
135on almost anything found in the contents.
136
137However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
138formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
139correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
140
141
1421.1. The HTTP transaction model
143-------------------------------
144
145The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100146to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100147from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
148connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200149will involve a new connection :
150
151 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
152
153In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
154establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
155by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
156length.
157
158Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
159to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
160however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
161response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
162header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
163
164 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
165
166Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
167power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
168but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200169a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100171Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
173second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
174page :
175
176 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
177
178This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
179latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
180correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
181the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100182server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200183
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100184The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
185time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
186are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
187parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
188carry the stream identifier.
189
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100190By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
191connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
192leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100193start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
194processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
195waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200196
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200197HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100198 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
199 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100200 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100201 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200202 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100203
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100204For HTTP/2, the connection mode resembles more the "server close" mode : given
205the independence of all streams, there is currently no place to hook the idle
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100206server connection after a response, so it is closed after the response. HTTP/2
207is only supported for incoming connections, not on connections going to
208servers.
209
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200210
2111.2. HTTP request
212-----------------
213
214First, let's consider this HTTP request :
215
216 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100217 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200218 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
219 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
220 3 User-agent: my small browser
221 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
222 5 Accept: image/png
223
224
2251.2.1. The Request line
226-----------------------
227
228Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
229
230 - a METHOD : GET
231 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
232 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
233
234All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
235which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
236followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
237is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
238desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
239the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
240
241The URI itself can have several forms :
242
243 - A "relative URI" :
244
245 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
246
247 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
248 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
249
250 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
251
252 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
253
254 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
255 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
256 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
257 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
258 must accept this form too.
259
260 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
261 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
262 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100263
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200264 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
265 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
266 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
267 other protocols too.
268
269In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
270mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
271on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
272It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
273specific to the language, framework or application in use.
274
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100275HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100276assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100277However, haproxy natively processes HTTP/1.x requests and headers, so requests
278received over an HTTP/2 connection are transcoded to HTTP/1.1 before being
279processed. This explains why they still appear as "HTTP/1.1" in haproxy's logs
280as well as in server logs.
281
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200282
2831.2.2. The request headers
284--------------------------
285
286The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
287beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
288an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
289Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
290values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
291encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
292the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
293define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
294
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100295Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200296their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100297"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
298as can be seen when running in debug mode.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200299
300The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
301that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
302is one valid form of empty line.
303
304Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
305headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
306about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
307application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
308
309Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000310 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200311 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
312 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
313 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
314
315
3161.3. HTTP response
317------------------
318
319An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
320messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
321
322 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100323 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200324 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
325 2 Content-length: 350
326 3 Content-Type: text/html
327
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200328As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
329codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
330response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100331continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
332the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
333following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
334sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
335(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
336correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
337such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
338state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
339over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
340if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
341information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200342
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200343
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003441.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200345------------------------
346
347Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
348
349 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
350 - a status code : 200
351 - a reason : OK
352
353The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100354 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
355 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
356 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
357 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
358 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200359
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000360Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100361"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200362found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
363messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
364or "Authentication Required".
365
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100366HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200367
368 Code When / reason
369 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
370 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
371 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
372 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100373 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
374 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200375 400 for an invalid or too large request
376 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
377 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200378 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100379 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200380 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Tham272e29b2020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100381 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
382 be available again
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200383 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
384 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
385 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200386 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200387 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
388 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
389 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
390
391The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3924.2).
393
394
3951.3.2. The response headers
396---------------------------
397
398Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
399the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
400details.
401
402
4032. Configuring HAProxy
404----------------------
405
4062.1. Configuration file format
407------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200408
409HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
410
411 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
412 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
413 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
414 "frontend" and "backend".
415
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100416The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
417referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200418delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100419
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200420
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004212.2. Quoting and escaping
422-------------------------
423
424HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
425many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
426with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
427single quotes.
428
429If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
430them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
431escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
432
433Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
434
435 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
436 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
437 \\ to use a backslash
438 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
439 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
440
441Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
442the interpretation of:
443
444 space as a parameter separator
445 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
446 # hash as a comment start
447
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200448Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
449-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
450backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
451
452Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200453quoting.
454
455Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
456nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
457
458Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
459equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
460
461 Example:
462 # those are equivalents:
463 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
464 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
465 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
466 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
467 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
468
469 # those are equivalents:
470 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
471 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
472 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
473 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
474
475
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004762.3. Environment variables
477--------------------------
478
479HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
480interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
481configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
482optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
483shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
484underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
485
486 Example:
487
488 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
489
490 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
491
492 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
493
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200494Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
495file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200496
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200497* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
498 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
499
500* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
501 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
502 directory.
503
504* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
505
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500506* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200507 processes, separated by semicolons.
508
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500509* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200510 CLI, separated by semicolons.
511
512See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200513
5142.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200515----------------
516
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100517Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100518values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
519otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
520numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
521for every keyword. Supported units are :
522
523 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
524 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
525 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
526 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
527 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
528 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
529
530
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00005312.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200532-------------
533
534 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
535 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
536 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
537 global
538 daemon
539 maxconn 256
540
541 defaults
542 mode http
543 timeout connect 5000ms
544 timeout client 50000ms
545 timeout server 50000ms
546
547 frontend http-in
548 bind *:80
549 default_backend servers
550
551 backend servers
552 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
553
554
555 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
556 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
557 global
558 daemon
559 maxconn 256
560
561 defaults
562 mode http
563 timeout connect 5000ms
564 timeout client 50000ms
565 timeout server 50000ms
566
567 listen http-in
568 bind *:80
569 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
570
571
572Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
573
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100574 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200575
576
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005773. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200578--------------------
579
580Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
581are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
582of them have command-line equivalents.
583
584The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
585
586 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200587 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200588 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200589 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200590 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200591 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200592 - description
593 - deviceatlas-json-file
594 - deviceatlas-log-level
595 - deviceatlas-separator
596 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900597 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200598 - gid
599 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100600 - hard-stop-after
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200601 - h1-case-adjust
602 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100603 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100604 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +0100605 - issuers-chain-path
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +0200606 - localpeer
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200607 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200608 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100609 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200610 - lua-load
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +0100611 - lua-prepend-path
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +0200612 - mworker-max-reloads
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200613 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200614 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200615 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200616 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +0200617 - pp2-never-send-local
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100618 - presetenv
619 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200620 - uid
621 - ulimit-n
622 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +0200623 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100624 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200625 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200626 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200627 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +0200628 - ssl-default-bind-curves
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200629 - ssl-default-bind-options
630 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200631 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200632 - ssl-default-server-options
633 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100634 - ssl-server-verify
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +0200635 - ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100636 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100637 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100638 - 51degrees-data-file
639 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200640 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200641 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200642 - wurfl-data-file
643 - wurfl-information-list
644 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200645 - wurfl-cache-size
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +0100646 - strict-limits
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100647
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200648 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +0100649 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200650 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200651 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200652 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100653 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100654 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100655 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200656 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200657 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200658 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200659 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200660 - noepoll
661 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +0000662 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200663 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100664 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300665 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000666 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +0100667 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200668 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200669 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200670 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000671 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000672 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200673 - tune.buffers.limit
674 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200675 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200676 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100677 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +0200678 - tune.fd.edge-triggered
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200679 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200680 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200681 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100682 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200683 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200684 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100685 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100686 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100687 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100688 - tune.lua.session-timeout
689 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200690 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100691 - tune.maxaccept
692 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200693 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200694 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200695 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100696 - tune.rcvbuf.client
697 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100698 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +0200699 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100700 - tune.sndbuf.client
701 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100702 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100703 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200704 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100705 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200706 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200707 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100708 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200709 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100710 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200711 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
712 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
713 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100714 - tune.zlib.memlevel
715 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100716
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200717 * Debugging
718 - debug
719 - quiet
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +0200720 - zero-warning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200721
722
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007233.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200724------------------------------------
725
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200726ca-base <dir>
727 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +0100728 relative path is used with "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" or "crl-file"
729 directives. Absolute locations specified in "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" and
730 "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200731
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200732chroot <jail dir>
733 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
734 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
735 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
736 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
737 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100738 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100739
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100740cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
741 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
742 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
743 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
744 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
745 set. These sets have the format
746
747 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
748
749 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100750 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100751 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
752 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100753 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
754 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100755 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100756 range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100757 or ranges may be specified, and the processes or threads will be allowed to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100758 bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100759 specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they
760 overlap. A thread will be bound on the intersection of its mapping and the
761 one of the process on which it is attached. If the intersection is null, no
762 specific binding will be set for the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100763
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100764 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
765 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
766 on the machine's word size.
767
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100768 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100769 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
770 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
771 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
772 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
773 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
774 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100775
776 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100777 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
778
779 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
780 # first 4 CPUs
781
782 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
783 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
784 # word size.
785
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100786 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100787 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100788 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
789 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
790 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
791
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100792 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
793 # and so on.
794 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
795 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
796 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
797
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100798 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100799 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
800 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
801 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
802
803 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
804 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
805 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
806
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100807 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
808 # and a thread range.
809 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
810 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
811 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
812
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200813crt-base <dir>
814 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
William Dauchy238ea3b2020-01-11 13:09:12 +0100815 path is used with "crtfile" or "crt" directives. Absolute locations specified
816 prevail and ignore "crt-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200817
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200818daemon
819 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
820 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +0100821 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
822 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200823
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200824deviceatlas-json-file <path>
825 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100826 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200827
828deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100829 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200830 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
831
832deviceatlas-separator <char>
833 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
834 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
835
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100836deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200837 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
838 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
839 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100840
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900841external-check
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100842 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
843 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100844 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
845 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
846 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
847 See "option external-check", and "insecure-fork-wanted", and
848 "insecure-setuid-wanted".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900849
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200850gid <number>
851 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
852 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
853 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100854 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
855 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200856 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100857
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +0100858group <group name>
859 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
860 See also "gid" and "user".
861
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100862hard-stop-after <time>
863 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
864
865 Arguments :
866 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
867 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
868 SIGUSR1 signal.
869
870 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
871 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
872 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
873
874 Example:
875 global
876 hard-stop-after 30s
877
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200878h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
879 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
880 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
881 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
882 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +0500883 adjusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200884 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
885 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
886 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
887 specified in a proxy.
888
889 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
890 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
891 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
892 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
893 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
894 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
895 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
896
897 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
898 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
899 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
900 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
901 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
902
903 Example:
904 global
905 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
906
907 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
908 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
909
910h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
911 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
912 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
913 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
914 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
915 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
916 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
917 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
918 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
919
920 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
921 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
922 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
923
924 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
925 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
926
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100927insecure-fork-wanted
928 By default haproxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
929 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
930 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
931 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
932 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
933 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
934 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
935 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
936 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within haproxy itself
937 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
938 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
939 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
940 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
941 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
942 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
943 disable it.
944
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100945insecure-setuid-wanted
946 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
947 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
948 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
949 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
950 aware of the risks. In a situation where haproxy would need to call external
951 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
952 haproxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
953 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
954 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
955 escalation in such a situation. This is what haproxy does by default. In case
956 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
957 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
958 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
959 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
960
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +0100961issuers-chain-path <dir>
962 Assigns a directory to load certificate chain for issuer completion. All
963 files must be in PEM format. For certificates loaded with "crt" or "crt-list",
964 if certificate chain is not included in PEM (also commonly known as
965 intermediate certificate), haproxy will complete chain if the issuer of the
966 certificate corresponds to the first certificate of the chain loaded with
967 "issuers-chain-path".
968 A "crt" file with PrivateKey+Certificate+IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1
969 could be replaced with PrivateKey+Certificate. HAProxy will complete the
970 chain if a file with IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1 is present in
971 "issuers-chain-path" directory. All other certificates with the same issuer
972 will share the chain in memory.
973
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +0200974localpeer <name>
975 Sets the local instance's peer name. It will be ignored if the "-L"
976 command line argument is specified or if used after "peers" section
977 definitions. In such cases, a warning message will be emitted during
978 the configuration parsing.
979
980 This option will also set the HAPROXY_LOCALPEER environment variable.
981 See also "-L" in the management guide and "peers" section below.
982
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +0200983log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
984 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +0100985 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100986 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100987 configured with "log global".
988
989 <address> can be one of:
990
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100991 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100992 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
993 port).
994
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100995 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
996 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
997 port).
998
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100999 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001000 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
1001 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001002 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001003
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001004 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
1005 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
1006 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
1007 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
1008 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
1009 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
1010 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
1011 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
1012 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
1013 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
1014 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow haproxy down
1015 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
1016 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
1017 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001018 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
1019 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001020
1021 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
1022 "fd@2", see above.
1023
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02001024 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
1025 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
1026 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
1027 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
1028 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
1029
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001030 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1031 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001032
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001033 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
1034 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
1035 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
1036 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1037 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1038 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1039 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1040 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1041 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1042 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001043 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1044 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001045
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001046 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1047 one of the following :
1048
1049 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
1050 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1051
1052 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1053 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1054
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001055 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1056 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1057 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1058 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1059 logger consumes.
1060
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001061 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1062 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1063 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1064 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1065
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001066 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1067 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1068 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1069 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1070 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1071
1072 <sample_size>
1073 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1074 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1075 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1076 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1077 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1078
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001079 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001080
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001081 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1082 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1083 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1084
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001085 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1086 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1087 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1088 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001089
1090 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001091 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1092 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1093 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1094 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1095 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1096 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001097
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001098 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001099
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001100log-send-hostname [<string>]
1101 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1102 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1103 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1104 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1105 the logs.
1106
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001107log-tag <string>
1108 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1109 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1110 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001111 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001112
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001113lua-load <file>
1114 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
1115 used multiple times.
1116
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001117lua-prepend-path <string> [<type>]
1118 Prepends the given string followed by a semicolon to Lua's package.<type>
1119 variable.
1120 <type> must either be "path" or "cpath". If <type> is not given it defaults
1121 to "path".
1122
1123 Lua's paths are semicolon delimited lists of patterns that specify how the
1124 `require` function attempts to find the source file of a library. Question
1125 marks (?) within a pattern will be replaced by module name. The path is
1126 evaluated left to right. This implies that paths that are prepended later
1127 will be checked earlier.
1128
1129 As an example by specifying the following path:
1130
1131 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?/init.lua
1132 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?.lua
1133
1134 When `require "example"` is being called Lua will first attempt to load the
1135 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example.lua script, if that does not exist the
1136 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example/init.lua will be attempted and the default
1137 paths if that does not exist either.
1138
1139 See https://www.lua.org/pil/8.1.html for the details within the Lua
1140 documentation.
1141
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001142master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001143 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1144 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1145 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001146 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001147 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
1148 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001149 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1150 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1151 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1152 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1153 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001154
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001155 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001156
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001157mworker-max-reloads <number>
1158 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001159 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001160 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1161 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1162 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1163
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001164nbproc <number>
1165 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
1166 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
1167 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001168 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
1169 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreau1f672a82019-01-26 14:20:55 +01001170 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon" and
1171 "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001172
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001173nbthread <number>
1174 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +01001175 makes haproxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
1176 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
1177 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
1178 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
1179 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001180 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
1181 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
1182 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
1183 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
1184 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
1185 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
1186 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001187
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001188pidfile <pidfile>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001189 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001190 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
1191 starting the process. See also "daemon".
1192
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001193pp2-never-send-local
1194 A bug in the PROXY protocol v2 implementation was present in HAProxy up to
1195 version 2.1, causing it to emit a PROXY command instead of a LOCAL command
1196 for health checks. This is particularly minor but confuses some servers'
1197 logs. Sadly, the bug was discovered very late and revealed that some servers
1198 which possibly only tested their PROXY protocol implementation against
1199 HAProxy fail to properly handle the LOCAL command, and permanently remain in
1200 the "down" state when HAProxy checks them. When this happens, it is possible
1201 to enable this global option to revert to the older (bogus) behavior for the
1202 time it takes to contact the affected components' vendors and get them fixed.
1203 This option is disabled by default and acts on all servers having the
1204 "send-proxy-v2" statement.
1205
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001206presetenv <name> <value>
1207 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1208 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1209 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1210 and "unsetenv".
1211
1212resetenv [<name> ...]
1213 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1214 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1215 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1216 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1217 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1218 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1219 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1220 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1221
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001222stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001223 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1224 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1225 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1226 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1227 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1228 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001229 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001230 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1231 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1232 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1233 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001234
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001235server-state-base <directory>
1236 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001237 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1238 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001239
1240server-state-file <file>
1241 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1242 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1243 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1244 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1245 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1246 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1247 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1248 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001249 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1250 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001251
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001252setenv <name> <value>
1253 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1254 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1255 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1256 and "unsetenv".
1257
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001258set-dumpable
1259 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001260 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
1261 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
1262 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
1263 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
1264 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
1265 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
1266 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
1267 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
1268 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
1269 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
1270 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
1271 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
1272 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
1273 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
1274 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
1275 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the haproxy process and verify that it
1276 leaves a core where expected when dying.
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001277
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001278ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1279 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1280 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001281 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001282 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001283 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1284 information and recommendations see e.g.
1285 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1286 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1287 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1288 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001289
1290ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1291 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1292 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1293 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1294 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1295 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001296 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1297 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1298 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001299 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001300
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001301ssl-default-bind-curves <curves>
1302 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1303 the default string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve
1304 suite") that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format
1305 of the string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
1306 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
1307
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001308ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1309 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1310 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1311 keyword to see available options.
1312
1313 Example:
1314 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001315 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001316
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001317ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1318 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1319 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001320 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001321 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001322 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1323 information and recommendations see e.g.
1324 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1325 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1326 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1327 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1328 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001329
1330ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1331 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1332 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1333 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1334 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1335 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001336 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1337 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1338 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1339 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001340
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001341ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1342 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1343 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1344 keyword to see available options.
1345
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001346ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1347 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1348 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1349 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001350 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001351 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001352 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1353 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1354 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1355 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001356 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1357 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1358 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1359
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001360ssl-load-extra-files <none|all|bundle|sctl|ocsp|issuer|key>*
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001361 This setting alters the way HAProxy will look for unspecified files during
1362 the loading of the SSL certificates.
1363
1364 By default, HAProxy discovers automatically a lot of files not specified in
1365 the configuration, and you may want to disable this behavior if you want to
1366 optimize the startup time.
1367
1368 "none": Only load the files specified in the configuration. Don't try to load
1369 a certificate bundle if the file does not exist. In the case of a directory,
1370 it won't try to bundle the certificates if they have the same basename.
1371
1372 "all": This is the default behavior, it will try to load everything,
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001373 bundles, sctl, ocsp, issuer, key.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001374
1375 "bundle": When a file specified in the configuration does not exist, HAProxy
1376 will try to load a certificate bundle. This is done by looking for
1377 <basename>.rsa, .ecdsa and .dsa. In the case of directories, HAProxy will
1378 try to gather the files with the same basename in a multi-certificate bundle.
1379 The bundles were introduced with OpenSSL 1.0.2 and were the only way back
1380 then to load an ECDSA certificate and a RSA one, with the same SNI. Since
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05001381 OpenSSL 1.1.1 it is not recommended anymore, you can specify both the ECDSA
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001382 and the RSA file on the bind line.
1383
1384 "sctl": Try to load "<basename>.sctl" for each crt keyword.
1385
1386 "ocsp": Try to load "<basename>.ocsp" for each crt keyword.
1387
1388 "issuer": Try to load "<basename>.issuer" if the issuer of the OCSP file is
1389 not provided in the PEM file.
1390
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001391 "key": If the private key was not provided by the PEM file, try to load a
1392 file "<basename>.key" containing a private key.
1393
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001394 The default behavior is "all".
1395
1396 Example:
1397 ssl-load-extra-files bundle sctl
1398 ssl-load-extra-files sctl ocsp issuer
1399 ssl-load-extra-files none
1400
1401 See also: "crt", section 5.1 about bind options.
1402
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001403ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1404 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1405 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1406 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1407
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001408ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
1409 Self issued CA, aka x509 root CA, is the enchor for chain validation: as a
1410 server is useless to send it, client must have it. Standard configuration
1411 need to not include such CA in PEM file. This option allows you to keep such
1412 CA in PEM file without sending it to the client. Use case is to provide
1413 issuer for ocsp without the need for '.issuer' file and be able to share it
1414 with 'issuers-chain-path'. This concerns all certificates without intermediate
1415 certificates. It's useless for BoringSSL, .issuer is ignored because ocsp
1416 bits does not need it.
1417
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001418stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1419 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1420 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1421 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001422 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001423 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001424
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001425 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1426 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1427 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001428
1429stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1430 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1431 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001432 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001433
1434stats maxconn <connections>
1435 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1436 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1437
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001438uid <number>
1439 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
1440 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1441 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1442 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1443
1444ulimit-n <number>
1445 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1446 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1447 option.
1448
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001449unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1450 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1451
1452 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1453 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1454 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1455 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1456 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1457 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1458 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1459 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1460 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1461 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1462
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001463unsetenv [<name> ...]
1464 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1465 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1466 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1467 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1468 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1469 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1470 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1471
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001472user <user name>
1473 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1474 See also "uid" and "group".
1475
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001476node <name>
1477 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1478
1479 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1480 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1481 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1482 traffic.
1483
1484description <text>
1485 Add a text that describes the instance.
1486
1487 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1488 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1489 "<" and ">" characters.
1490
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100149151degrees-data-file <file path>
1492 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001493 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001494
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001495 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001496 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1497
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000149851degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001499 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1500 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1501 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1502
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001503 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001504 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1505
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200150651degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001507 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1508 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1509
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001510 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1511 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1512
151351degrees-cache-size <number>
1514 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1515 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1516 By default, this cache is disabled.
1517
1518 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001519 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1520
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001521wurfl-data-file <file path>
1522 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1523 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1524
1525 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1526 with USE_WURFL=1.
1527
1528wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1529 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1530 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1531 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1532
1533 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1534
1535 Valid WURFL properties are:
1536 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1537
1538 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1539 device.
1540
1541 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1542 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1543
1544 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1545 particular web request.
1546
1547 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1548 used Libwurfl API version.
1549
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001550 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1551 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1552
1553 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1554 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1555
1556 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1557
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001558 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1559 with USE_WURFL=1.
1560
1561wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1562 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1563 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1564
1565 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1566 with USE_WURFL=1.
1567
1568wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1569 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1570 thus before the chroot.
1571
1572 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1573 with USE_WURFL=1.
1574
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001575wurfl-cache-size <size>
1576 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
1577 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001578 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001579 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001580
1581 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1582 with USE_WURFL=1.
1583
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001584strict-limits
1585 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. Haproxy is tries to set
1586 the best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it
1587 will emit a warning. Use this option if you want an explicit failure of
1588 haproxy when those limits fail. This option is disabled by default. If it has
1589 been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no"
1590 keyword.
1591
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015923.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001593-----------------------
1594
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01001595busy-polling
1596 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
1597 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
1598 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
1599 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
1600 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
1601 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
1602 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
1603 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
1604 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
1605 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
1606 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
1607 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
1608 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
1609 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
1610 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
1611 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
1612 "poll" pollers.
1613
William Dauchy3894d972019-12-28 15:36:02 +01001614 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
1615 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
1616 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
1617
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001618max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1619 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1620 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1621 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1622 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1623 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1624 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1625 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1626 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1627
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001628maxconn <number>
1629 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1630 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1631 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001632 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1633 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1634 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1635 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01001636 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
1637 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
1638 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
1639 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
1640 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
1641 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001642
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001643maxconnrate <number>
1644 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1645 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1646 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1647 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1648 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1649 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1650 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1651 fairness.
1652
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001653maxcomprate <number>
1654 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001655 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001656 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1657 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1658 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001659 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001660 default value.
1661
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001662maxcompcpuusage <number>
1663 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1664 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1665 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1666 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1667 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1668 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1669 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1670 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1671
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001672maxpipes <number>
1673 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1674 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1675 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1676 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1677 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1678 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1679
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001680maxsessrate <number>
1681 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1682 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1683 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1684 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1685 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1686 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1687 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1688 fairness.
1689
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001690maxsslconn <number>
1691 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1692 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1693 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1694 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1695 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1696 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1697 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001698 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1699 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1700 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1701 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1702 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1703 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1704 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001705
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001706maxsslrate <number>
1707 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1708 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1709 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1710 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1711 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1712 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1713 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1714 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1715 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1716 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1717
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001718maxzlibmem <number>
1719 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1720 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1721 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001722 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1723 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1724 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1725
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001726noepoll
1727 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1728 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001729 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001730
1731nokqueue
1732 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1733 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1734 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1735
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001736noevports
1737 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
1738 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
1739 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
1740 also "nopoll".
1741
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001742nopoll
1743 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1744 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001745 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001746 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
1747 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001748
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001749nosplice
1750 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001751 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001752 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001753 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001754 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1755 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1756 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1757 "option splice-response".
1758
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001759nogetaddrinfo
1760 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1761 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1762
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001763noreuseport
1764 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1765 command line argument "-dR".
1766
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001767profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
1768 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
1769 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
1770 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
1771 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001772 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001773 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
1774 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
1775 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
1776 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
1777
1778 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
1779 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
1780 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
1781 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
1782 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001783 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
1784 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
1785 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
1786 CLI.
1787
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001788spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001789 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1790 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1791 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1792 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1793 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1794 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001795
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001796ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001797 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001798 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001799 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
1800 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
1801 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
1802 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
1803 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001804 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
1805 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001806 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
1807 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
1808 openssl configuration file uses:
1809 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
1810
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001811ssl-mode-async
1812 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02001813 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001814 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
1815 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
1816 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001817 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001818 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001819
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001820tune.buffers.limit <number>
1821 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1822 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1823 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1824 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1825 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001826 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001827 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1828 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1829 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1830 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1831 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1832 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1833 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1834 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1835 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1836
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001837tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1838 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1839 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1840 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1841 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1842
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001843tune.bufsize <number>
1844 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1845 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1846 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1847 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1848 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1849 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1850 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01001851 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
1852 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
1853 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001854 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01001855 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
1856 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
1857 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001858
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001859tune.chksize <number>
1860 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1861 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1862 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1863 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1864 checks whenever possible.
1865
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001866tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1867 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1868 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1869 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1870 this value. The default value is 1.
1871
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01001872tune.fail-alloc
1873 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
1874 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
1875 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
1876 gracefully.
1877
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02001878tune.fd.edge-triggered { on | off } [ EXPERIMENTAL ]
1879 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the edge-triggered polling mode for FDs
1880 that support it. This is currently only support with epoll. It may noticeably
1881 reduce the number of epoll_ctl() calls and slightly improve performance in
1882 certain scenarios. This is still experimental, it may result in frozen
1883 connections if bugs are still present, and is disabled by default.
1884
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001885tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
1886 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
1887 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
1888 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
1889 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
1890 change it.
1891
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001892tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
1893 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001894 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
1895 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001896 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
1897 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
1898 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
1899 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
1900 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
1901
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001902tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
1903 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
1904 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
1905 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
1906 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
1907 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
1908 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
1909 recommended not to change this value.
1910
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01001911tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
1912 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that haproxy announces it is willing to
1913 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
1914 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, haproxy will not announce support
1915 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
1916 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
1917 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
1918 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
1919
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001920tune.http.cookielen <number>
1921 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1922 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1923 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1924 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1925 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1926 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1927 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1928 to change this value.
1929
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001930tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001931 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
1932 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001933 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001934 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001935 configuration directives too.
1936 The default value is 1024.
1937
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001938tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1939 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1940 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1941 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1942 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1943 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1944 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02001945 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
1946 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
1947 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001948
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001949tune.idletimer <timeout>
1950 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1951 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1952 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1953 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1954 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1955 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001956 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001957 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001958 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1959
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01001960tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
1961 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
1962 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
1963 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
1964 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
1965 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
1966 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
1967 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
1968 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
1969 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
1970
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001971tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1972 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01001973 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001974 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1975 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001976 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001977 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1978 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1979
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001980tune.lua.maxmem
1981 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1982 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1983 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1984 memory.
1985
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001986tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1987 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001988 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1989 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001990 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001991
1992tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1993 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1994 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1995 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1996 check servers.
1997
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001998tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
1999 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
2000 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2001 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002002 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002003
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002004tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01002005 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
2006 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
2007 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
2008 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
2009 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
2010 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
2011 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
2012 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
2013 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
2014 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002015
2016tune.maxpollevents <number>
2017 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
2018 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
2019 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
2020 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
2021 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
2022
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002023tune.maxrewrite <number>
2024 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
2025 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
2026 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
2027 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
2028 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
2029 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
2030 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
2031 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
2032 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
2033 bufsize.
2034
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002035tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
2036 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
2037 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
2038 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
2039 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
2040 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
2041 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
2042 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
2043 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
2044 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02002045 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
2046 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002047 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
2048 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
2049 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
2050 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
2051 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
2052 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
2053 setting this parameter to 0.
2054
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02002055tune.pipesize <number>
2056 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
2057 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
2058 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
2059 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
2060 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
2061 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
2062
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002063tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
2064 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2065 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2066 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
2067 default is 20.
2068
2069tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
2070 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2071 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2072 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
2073 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
2074 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
2075 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002076 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002077
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002078tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
2079tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
2080 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
2081 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2082 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002083 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002084 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002085 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2086 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2087
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002088tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002089 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002090 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
2091 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
2092 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
2093 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
2094
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002095tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002096 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002097 tasks. The default value is 200. Increasing it may incur latency when
2098 dealing with I/Os, making it too small can incur extra overhead.
2099
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002100tune.sndbuf.client <number>
2101tune.sndbuf.server <number>
2102 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
2103 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2104 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002105 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002106 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002107 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2108 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2109 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
2110 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
2111 notifying haproxy again.
2112
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002113tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002114 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
2115 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
2116 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002117 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002118 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002119 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002120 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
2121 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
2122 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01002123 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
2124 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002125
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002126tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02002127 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002128 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
2129 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
2130 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
2131 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
2132 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
2133
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002134tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
2135 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002136 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002137 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
2138 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
2139 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
2140 being used for too long.
2141
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002142tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
2143 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
2144 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
2145 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
2146 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
2147 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
2148 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
2149 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
2150 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
2151 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
2152 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002153 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002154 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002155
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002156tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
2157 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
2158 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
2159 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
2160 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
Willy Tarreau3ba77d22020-05-08 09:31:18 +02002161 this maximum value. Default value if 2048. Only 1024 or higher values are
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002162 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
2163 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002164 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
2165 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002166
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02002167tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
2168 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
2169 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
2170 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
2171 1000 entries.
2172
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01002173tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
2174 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
2175 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
2176 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
2177
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002178tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002179tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002180tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
2181tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
2182tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002183 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
2184 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
2185 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
2186 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
2187 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
2188 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
2189 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
2190 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002191
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01002192 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
2193 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
2194 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
2195 all available space is consumed.
2196 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
2197 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
2198 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002199
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002200tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
2201 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002202 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002203 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002204 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002205 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
2206
2207tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2208 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2209 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002210 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2211 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002212
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022133.3. Debugging
2214--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002215
Willy Tarreau1b857852020-02-25 11:27:22 +01002216debug (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002217 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
2218 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
2219 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
2220 system startup.
2221
2222quiet
2223 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2224 line argument "-q".
2225
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002226zero-warning
2227 When this option is set, haproxy will refuse to start if any warning was
2228 emitted while processing the configuration. It is highly recommended to set
2229 this option on configurations that are not changed often, as it helps detect
2230 subtle mistakes and keep the configuration clean and forward-compatible. Note
2231 that "haproxy -c" will also report errors in such a case. This option is
2232 equivalent to command line argument "-dW".
2233
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002234
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010022353.4. Userlists
2236--------------
2237It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2238http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2239it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2240
2241userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002242 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002243 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2244
2245group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002246 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002247 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2248 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2249
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002250user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2251 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002252 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2253 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002254 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2255 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2256 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2257 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002258
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002259 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2260 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2261 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2262 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2263 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2264 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2265 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
2266 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
2267 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002268
2269 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002270 userlist L1
2271 group G1 users tiger,scott
2272 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002273
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002274 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2275 user scott insecure-password elgato
2276 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002277
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002278 userlist L2
2279 group G1
2280 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002281
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002282 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2283 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2284 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002285
2286 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002287
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002288
22893.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002290----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002291It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
2292several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
2293instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2294values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2295automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2296In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2297using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2298tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2299reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2300Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2301that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2302each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002303
2304peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002305 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002306 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2307
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002308bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2309 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2310 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2311
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002312disabled
2313 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2314 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2315 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2316
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002317default-bind [param*]
2318 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2319
2320default-server [param*]
2321 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2322
2323 Arguments:
2324 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2325 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2326 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2327 details.
2328
2329
2330 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
2331
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002332enable
2333 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
2334
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01002335log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
2336 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
2337 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
2338 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
2339 more details.
2340
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002341peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002342 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
2343 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02002344 using "-L" command line option or "localpeer" global configuration setting),
2345 haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer connection on <ip>:<port>.
2346 Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to in order to join the
2347 remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to identify and
2348 validate the remote peer on the server side.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002349
2350 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
2351 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
2352
2353 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02002354 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument or the "localpeer"
2355 global configuration setting to change the local peer name. This makes it
2356 easier to maintain coherent configuration files across all peers.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002357
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002358 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
2359 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002360
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002361 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
2362 "server" keyword explanation below).
2363
2364server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02002365 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002366 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
2367 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
2368 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
2369 of this "peers" section).
2370 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
2371
2372
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002373 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002374 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002375 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002376 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
2377 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
2378 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002379
2380 backend mybackend
2381 mode tcp
2382 balance roundrobin
2383 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
2384 stick on src
2385
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002386 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2387 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002388
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002389 Example:
2390 peers mypeers
2391 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
2392 default-server ssl verify none
2393 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
2394 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002395
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002396
2397table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
2398 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
2399
2400 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
2401 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002402 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002403 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
2404 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
2405 "stick-table" keyword).
2406
2407 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
2408 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
2409 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
2410 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
2411 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
2412 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
2413 of the stick-table name as follows:
2414
2415 peers mypeers
2416 peer A ...
2417 peer B ...
2418 table t1 ...
2419
2420 frontend fe1
2421 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
2422
2423 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
2424 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
2425
2426 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
2427 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
2428 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
2429 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
2430 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
2431 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
2432 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
2433
2434 peers mypeers
2435 peer A ...
2436 peer B ...
2437 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
2438
2439 backend t1
2440 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
2441
2442 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
2443 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
2444 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
2445
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090024463.6. Mailers
2447------------
2448It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
2449If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
2450in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
2451
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02002452mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002453 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
2454 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
2455
2456mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
2457 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
2458
2459 Example:
2460 mailers mymailers
2461 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
2462 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
2463
2464 backend mybackend
2465 mode tcp
2466 balance roundrobin
2467
2468 email-alert mailers mymailers
2469 email-alert from test1@horms.org
2470 email-alert to test2@horms.org
2471
2472 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2473 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
2474
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01002475timeout mail <time>
2476 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
2477 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
2478 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
2479 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
2480
2481 Example:
2482 mailers mymailers
2483 timeout mail 20s
2484 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002485
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020024863.7. Programs
2487-------------
2488In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
2489master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
2490managed the same way as the workers.
2491
2492During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
2493sequence as a worker:
2494
2495 - the master is re-executed
2496 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
2497 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
2498 instance of the program
2499
2500During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
2501
2502program <name>
2503 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
2504 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
2505 the management guide).
2506
2507command <command> [arguments*]
2508 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
2509 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
2510 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
2511 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
2512
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08002513user <user name>
2514 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2515 See also "group".
2516
2517group <group name>
2518 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
2519 See also "user".
2520
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02002521option start-on-reload
2522no option start-on-reload
2523 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
2524 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
2525 program section.
2526
2527
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +010025283.8. HTTP-errors
2529----------------
2530
2531It is possible to globally declare several groups of HTTP errors, to be
2532imported afterwards in any proxy section. Same group may be referenced at
2533several places and can be fully or partially imported.
2534
2535http-errors <name>
2536 Create a new http-errors group with the name <name>. It is an independent
2537 section that may be referenced by one or more proxies using its name.
2538
2539errorfile <code> <file>
2540 Associate a file contents to an HTTP error code
2541
2542 Arguments :
2543 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02002544 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
2545 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01002546
2547 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
2548 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
2549 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
2550 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2551 before any chroot is performed.
2552
2553 Please referrers to "errorfile" keyword in section 4 for details.
2554
2555 Example:
2556 http-errors website-1
2557 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/400.http
2558 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/404.http
2559 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
2560
2561 http-errors website-2
2562 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/400.http
2563 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/404.http
2564 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
2565
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +020025663.9. Rings
2567----------
2568
2569It is possible to globally declare ring-buffers, to be used as target for log
2570servers or traces.
2571
2572ring <ringname>
2573 Creates a new ring-buffer with name <ringname>.
2574
2575description <text>
2576 The descritpition is an optional description string of the ring. It will
2577 appear on CLI. By default, <name> is reused to fill this field.
2578
2579format <format>
2580 Format used to store events into the ring buffer.
2581
2582 Arguments:
2583 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
2584 one of the following :
2585
2586 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
2587 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
2588 designed to be used with a local log server.
2589
2590 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
2591 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
2592 used in containers or during development, where the severity
2593 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr). This
2594 is the default.
2595
2596 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
2597 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
2598
2599 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
2600 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
2601
2602 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
2603 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
2604 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
2605 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
2606 logger consumes.
2607
2608 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
2609 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
2610 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
2611 used with a local log server.
2612
2613maxlen <length>
2614 The maximum length of an event message stored into the ring,
2615 including formatted header. If an event message is longer than
2616 <length>, it will be truncated to this length.
2617
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02002618server <name> <address> [param*]
2619 Used to configure a syslog tcp server to forward messages from ring buffer.
2620 This supports for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph. Some of
2621 these parameters are irrelevant for "ring" sections. Important point: there
2622 is little reason to add more than one server to a ring, because all servers
2623 will receive the exact same copy of the ring contents, and as such the ring
2624 will progress at the speed of the slowest server. If one server does not
2625 respond, it will prevent old messages from being purged and may block new
2626 messages from being inserted into the ring. The proper way to send messages
2627 to multiple servers is to use one distinct ring per log server, not to
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02002628 attach multiple servers to the same ring. Note that specific server directive
2629 "log-proto" is used to set the protocol used to send messages.
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02002630
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002631size <size>
2632 This is the optional size in bytes for the ring-buffer. Default value is
2633 set to BUFSIZE.
2634
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02002635timeout connect <timeout>
2636 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2637
2638 Arguments :
2639 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
2640 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2641 as explained at the top of this document.
2642
2643timeout server <timeout>
2644 Set the maximum time for pending data staying into output buffer.
2645
2646 Arguments :
2647 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
2648 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2649 as explained at the top of this document.
2650
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002651 Example:
2652 global
2653 log ring@myring local7
2654
2655 ring myring
2656 description "My local buffer"
2657 format rfc3164
2658 maxlen 1200
2659 size 32764
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02002660 timeout connect 5s
2661 timeout server 10s
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02002662 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:6514 log-proto octet-count
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002663
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01002664
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026654. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002666----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002667
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002668Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02002669 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002670 - frontend <name>
2671 - backend <name>
2672 - listen <name>
2673
2674A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
2675its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
2676section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002677section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002678
2679A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
2680connections.
2681
2682A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
2683to forward incoming connections.
2684
2685A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
2686parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
2687
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002688All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
2689'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
2690case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
2691
2692Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
2693logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
2694proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
2695However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
2696name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
2697
2698Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
2699and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002700bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002701protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
2702modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
2703arbitrary criteria.
2704
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002705In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
2706a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto21ad3152019-12-10 13:11:17 +01002707the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002708
2709 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
2710 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
2711 between responses and new requests.
2712
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002713 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
2714 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
2715 client-facing connection remains open.
2716
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002717 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
2718 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002719
2720The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
2721frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
2722following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002723weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002724
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002725 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002726
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002727 | KAL | SCL | CLO
2728 ----+-----+-----+----
2729 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
2730 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002731 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
2732 ----+-----+-----+----
2733 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002734
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002735
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002736
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020027374.1. Proxy keywords matrix
2738--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002739
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002740The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
2741limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
2742they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
2743limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002744marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002745option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02002746and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
2747with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
2748specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002749
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002750
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002751 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
2752------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2753acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002754backlog X X X -
2755balance X - X X
2756bind - X X -
2757bind-process X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002758capture cookie - X X -
2759capture request header - X X -
2760capture response header - X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002761compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002762cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002763declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002764default-server X - X X
2765default_backend X X X -
2766description - X X X
2767disabled X X X X
2768dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002769email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002770email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002771email-alert mailers X X X X
2772email-alert myhostname X X X X
2773email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002774enabled X X X X
2775errorfile X X X X
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01002776errorfiles X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002777errorloc X X X X
2778errorloc302 X X X X
2779-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2780errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002781force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002782filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002783fullconn X - X X
2784grace X X X X
2785hash-type X - X X
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01002786http-after-response - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02002787http-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02002788http-check connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002789http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02002790http-check expect X - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02002791http-check send-state X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02002792http-check set-var X - X X
2793http-check unset-var X - X X
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02002794http-error X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002795http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002796http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02002797http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02002798http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002799id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002800ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002801load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002802log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01002803log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02002804log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01002805log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02002806max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002807maxconn X X X -
2808mode X X X X
2809monitor fail - X X -
2810monitor-net X X X -
2811monitor-uri X X X -
2812option abortonclose (*) X - X X
2813option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
2814option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
2815option allbackups (*) X - X X
2816option checkcache (*) X - X X
2817option clitcpka (*) X X X -
2818option contstats (*) X X X -
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02002819option disable-h2-upgrade (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002820option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
2821option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002822-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2823option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02002824option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
2825option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02002826option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02002827option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01002828option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02002829option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02002830option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002831option http-server-close (*) X X X X
2832option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
2833option httpchk X - X X
2834option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01002835option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002836option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002837option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02002838option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002839option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002840option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
2841option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
2842option logasap (*) X X X -
2843option mysql-check X - X X
2844option nolinger (*) X X X X
2845option originalto X X X X
2846option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02002847option pgsql-check X - X X
2848option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002849option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02002850option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002851option smtpchk X - X X
2852option socket-stats (*) X X X -
2853option splice-auto (*) X X X X
2854option splice-request (*) X X X X
2855option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01002856option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002857option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
2858option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
2859-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01002860option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002861option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
2862option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
2863option tcpka X X X X
2864option tcplog X X X X
2865option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002866external-check command X - X X
2867external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002868persist rdp-cookie X - X X
2869rate-limit sessions X X X -
2870redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002871-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002872retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02002873retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002874server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002875server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02002876server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002877source X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02002878stats admin - X X X
2879stats auth X X X X
2880stats enable X X X X
2881stats hide-version X X X X
2882stats http-request - X X X
2883stats realm X X X X
2884stats refresh X X X X
2885stats scope X X X X
2886stats show-desc X X X X
2887stats show-legends X X X X
2888stats show-node X X X X
2889stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002890-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2891stick match - - X X
2892stick on - - X X
2893stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02002894stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01002895stick-table - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02002896tcp-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02002897tcp-check connect X - X X
2898tcp-check expect X - X X
2899tcp-check send X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02002900tcp-check send-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02002901tcp-check send-binary X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02002902tcp-check send-binary-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02002903tcp-check set-var X - X X
2904tcp-check unset-var X - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02002905tcp-request connection - X X -
2906tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02002907tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02002908tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02002909tcp-response content - - X X
2910tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002911timeout check X - X X
2912timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002913timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002914timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002915timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
2916timeout http-request X X X X
2917timeout queue X - X X
2918timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002919timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002920timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02002921timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002922transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01002923unique-id-format X X X -
2924unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002925use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02002926use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02002927use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002928------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2929 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002930
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002931
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020029324.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
2933---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002934
2935This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
2936
2937
2938acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
2939 Declare or complete an access list.
2940 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2941 no | yes | yes | yes
2942 Example:
2943 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2944 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2945 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2946
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002947 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002948
2949
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002950backlog <conns>
2951 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
2952 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2953 yes | yes | yes | no
2954 Arguments :
2955 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
2956 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002957 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002958
2959 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
2960 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
2961 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
2962 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
2963 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
2964 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
2965 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
2966 backlog parameter.
2967
2968 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
2969 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
2970 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
2971
2972 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
2973
2974
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002975balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002976balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002977 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
2978 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2979 yes | no | yes | yes
2980 Arguments :
2981 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
2982 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
2983 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
2984 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
2985
2986 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2987 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
2988 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
2989 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002990 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08002991 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002992 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
2993 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
2994 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
2995 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
2996 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
2997 it, so that you don't worry.
2998
2999 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3000 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
3001 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
3002 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
3003 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
3004 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
3005 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
3006 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003007
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003008 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
3009 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
3010 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
3011 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
3012 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
3013 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
3014 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
3015 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
3016
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003017 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003018 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003019 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
3020 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003021 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003022 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
3023 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
3024 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
3025 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
3026 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003027 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
3028 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
3029 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
3030 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
3031 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
3032 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003033
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003034 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
3035 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
3036 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
3037 address will always reach the same server as long as no
3038 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
3039 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
3040 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
3041 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003042 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003043 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003044 static by default, which means that changing a server's
3045 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
3046 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003047
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003048 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
3049 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
3050 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
3051 the running servers. The result designates which server will
3052 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
3053 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
3054 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
3055 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
3056 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
3057 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3058 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3059 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003060
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003061 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003062 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
3063 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
3064 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
3065 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
3066 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
3067 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
3068 URIs start with a leading "/".
3069
3070 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
3071 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
3072 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
3073 evaluation stops when either is reached.
3074
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003075 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003076 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
3077
3078 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003079 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
3080 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003081 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
3082 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
3083 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
3084 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003085 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003086 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
3087 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003088
3089 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
3090 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
3091 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
3092 server will receive the request.
3093
3094 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
3095 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
3096 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
3097 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
3098 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003099 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
3100 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
3101 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003102
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003103 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
3104 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
3105 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
3106 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
3107 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003108
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003109 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003110 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
3111 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
3112 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
3113
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003114 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3115 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3116 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3117
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003118 random
3119 random(<draws>)
3120 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003121 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
3122 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
3123 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
3124 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003125 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
3126 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
3127 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
3128 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
3129 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
3130 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
3131 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
3132 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
3133 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
3134 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
3135 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
3136 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
3137 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
3138 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
3139 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
3140 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
3141 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
3142 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
3143 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
3144 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003145
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003146 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02003147 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003148 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
3149 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
3150 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
3151 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
3152 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
3153 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003154 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003155 used instead.
3156
3157 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
3158 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
3159 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
3160 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
3161
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003162 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3163 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3164 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3165
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003166 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09003167
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003168 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003169 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
3170 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003171
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01003172 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
3173 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
3174 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003175
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003176 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003177 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003178 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
3179 NTLM relies on.
3180
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003181 Examples :
3182 balance roundrobin
3183 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003184 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003185 balance hdr(User-Agent)
3186 balance hdr(host)
3187 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003188
3189 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
3190 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
3191
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003192 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003193 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
3194 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
3195 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02003196 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003197
3198 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
3199 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
3200 defaults to 16 kB.
3201
3202 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
3203 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
3204
3205 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
3206 Round Robin.
3207
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00003208 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003209 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
3210 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
3211 actually appeared in the first chunk).
3212
3213 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
3214
3215 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003216 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003217 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
3218 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
3219 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003220
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003221 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003222
3223
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003224bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
3225bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003226 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
3227 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3228 no | yes | yes | no
3229 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003230 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
3231 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
3232 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
3233 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01003234 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003235 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
3236 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
3237 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
3238 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
3239 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
3240 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
3241 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02003242 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
3243 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
3244 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
3245 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
3246 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
3247 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
3248 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01003249 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
3250 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
3251 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02003252 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
3253 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
3254 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
3255 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003256 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
3257 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
3258 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003259
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003260 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
3261 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003262 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
3263 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
3264 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003265 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
3266 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
3267 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
3268 the range.
3269
3270 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
3271 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
3272 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
3273 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
3274 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
3275 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
3276 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003277 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003278 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003279
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003280 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003281 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003282 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
3283 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
3284 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
3285 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
3286 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
3287 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
3288
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003289 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
3290 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
3291 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
3292 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003293
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003294 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
3295 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
3296 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
3297 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
3298 in a frontend.
3299
3300 Example :
3301 listen http_proxy
3302 bind :80,:443
3303 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003304 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003305
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003306 listen http_https_proxy
3307 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02003308 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003309
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003310 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
3311 bind ipv6@:80
3312 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
3313 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
3314
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003315 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003316 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003317
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02003318 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
3319 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
3320 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
3321 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
3322 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
3323
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003324 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003325 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003326
3327
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003328bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003329 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
3330 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3331 yes | yes | yes | yes
3332 Arguments :
3333 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
3334 may be used to override a default value.
3335
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003336 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003337 option may be combined with other numbers.
3338
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003339 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003340 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
3341 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
3342 missing from all processes.
3343
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003344 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003345 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003346 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
3347 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
3348 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
3349 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
3350 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02003351 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003352
3353 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
3354 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
3355 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
3356 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
3357 and 'even' instances.
3358
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003359 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
3360 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
3361 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
3362 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003363
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003364 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
3365 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
3366
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02003367 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
3368 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
3369 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
3370
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003371 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
3372 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
3373
3374 Example :
3375 listen app_ip1
3376 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003377 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003378
3379 listen app_ip2
3380 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003381 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003382
3383 listen management
3384 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003385 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003386
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01003387 listen management
3388 bind 10.0.0.4:80
3389 bind-process 1-4
3390
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003391 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003392
3393
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003394capture cookie <name> len <length>
3395 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
3396 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3397 no | yes | yes | no
3398 Arguments :
3399 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
3400 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
3401 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
3402 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003403 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003404
3405 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
3406 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
3407 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
3408 right if it exceeds <length>.
3409
3410 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
3411 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
3412 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
3413 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
3414
3415 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
3416 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
3417 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
3418
3419 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
3420 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
3421 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01003422 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
3423 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
3424 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003425
3426 Example:
3427 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
3428
3429 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003430 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003431
3432
3433capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003434 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003435 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3436 no | yes | yes | no
3437 Arguments :
3438 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003439 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003440 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
3441 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3442 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3443
3444 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3445 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3446 it exceeds <length>.
3447
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003448 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003449 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
3450 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003451 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
3452 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
3453 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
3454 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003455 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003456 environments to find where the request came from.
3457
3458 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
3459 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
3460 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
3461 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003462
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003463 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
3464 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3465 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3466 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3467 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003468
3469 Example:
3470 capture request header Host len 15
3471 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01003472 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003473
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003474 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003475 about logging.
3476
3477
3478capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003479 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003480 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3481 no | yes | yes | no
3482 Arguments :
3483 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003484 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003485 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
3486 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3487 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3488
3489 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3490 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3491 it exceeds <length>.
3492
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003493 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003494 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
3495 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
3496 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003497 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
3498 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
3499 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
3500 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003501
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003502 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
3503 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3504 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3505 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3506 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003507
3508 Example:
3509 capture response header Content-length len 9
3510 capture response header Location len 15
3511
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003512 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003513 about logging.
3514
3515
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003516compression algo <algorithm> ...
3517compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003518compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003519 Enable HTTP compression.
3520 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3521 yes | yes | yes | yes
3522 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003523 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
3524 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
3525 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
3526
3527 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003528 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
3529 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
3530 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003531
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003532 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003533 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003534
3535 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
3536 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
3537 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
3538 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
3539 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003540 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003541
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003542 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
3543 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
3544 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
3545 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
3546 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
3547 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
3548 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003549 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003550
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04003551 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003552 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003553 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
3554 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
3555 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
3556 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
3557 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003558
3559 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
3560 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
3561 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
3562 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
3563 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003564 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
3565 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
3566 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
3567 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
3568 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02003569 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
3570 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003571
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003572 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003573 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
3574 "Accept-Encoding" header
3575 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003576 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003577 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
3578 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
3579 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
3580 "multipart"
3581 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
3582 header
3583 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
3584 and later
3585 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
3586 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003587 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003588
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01003589 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003590
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003591 Examples :
3592 compression algo gzip
3593 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003594
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003595
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003596cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003597 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
3598 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01003599 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003600 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
3601 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3602 yes | no | yes | yes
3603 Arguments :
3604 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
3605 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
3606 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
3607 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
3608 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
3609 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003610 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003611 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
3612 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
3613
3614 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
3615 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
3616 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
3617 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
3618 headers is left to the application. The application can then
3619 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003620 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
3621 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003622 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003623 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
3624 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003625
3626 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003627 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003628
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003629 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003630 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02003631 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003632 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003633 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
3634 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
3635 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
3636 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
3637 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
3638 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
3639 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003640
3641 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
3642 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
3643 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
3644 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
3645 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
3646 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
3647 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
3648 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
3649 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003650 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003651 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
3652 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
3653 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003654
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003655 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
3656 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
3657 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003658 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
3659 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
3660 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
3661 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003662 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
3663 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
3664 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003665
3666 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
3667 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
3668 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
3669 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
3670 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
3671 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
3672 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
3673 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
3674 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
3675
3676 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
3677 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
3678 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
3679 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
3680 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
3681 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
3682 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
3683 persistence cookie in the cache.
3684 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
3685
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003686 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
3687 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
3688 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
3689 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
3690 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003691 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003692 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
3693 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
3694 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
3695 they logout.
3696
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003697 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
3698 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
3699 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
3700 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
3701
3702 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
3703 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
3704 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
3705 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
3706 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
3707 this attribute.
3708
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003709 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003710 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01003711 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
3712 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
3713 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
3714 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
3715 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
3716 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003717
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003718 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
3719 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
3720 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
3721 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
3722 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
3723 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
3724 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
3725 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003726 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003727 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
3728 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
3729 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
3730 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
3731 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
3732 the site.
3733
3734 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
3735 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
3736 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
3737 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
3738 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
3739 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
3740 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
3741 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
3742 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
3743 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
3744 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
3745 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
3746 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003747 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003748 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
3749 redispatch after some absolute delay.
3750
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003751 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
3752 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
3753 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
3754 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
3755 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
3756 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
3757
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01003758 attr This option tells haproxy to add an extra attribute when a
3759 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
3760 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
3761 repeated.
3762
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003763 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
3764 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
3765 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
3766 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003767
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003768 Examples :
3769 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
3770 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
3771 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003772 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003773
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003774 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003775
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003776
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003777declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
3778 Declares a capture slot.
3779 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3780 no | yes | yes | no
3781 Arguments:
3782 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
3783
3784 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
3785 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
3786 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
3787 for use in the response.
3788
3789 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02003790 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003791 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
3792
3793
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003794default-server [param*]
3795 Change default options for a server in a backend
3796 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3797 yes | no | yes | yes
3798 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003799 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3800 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
3801 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
3802 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003803
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003804 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003805 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
3806
3807 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003808
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003809
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003810default_backend <backend>
3811 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
3812 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3813 yes | yes | yes | no
3814 Arguments :
3815 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
3816
3817 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
3818 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
3819 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
3820 will catch all undetermined requests.
3821
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003822 Example :
3823
3824 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
3825 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
3826 default_backend dynamic
3827
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02003828 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003829
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003830
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02003831description <string>
3832 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
3833 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3834 no | yes | yes | yes
3835 Arguments : string
3836
3837 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
3838 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
3839 it describes.
3840 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
3841
3842
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003843disabled
3844 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3845 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3846 yes | yes | yes | yes
3847 Arguments : none
3848
3849 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
3850 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
3851 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
3852 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
3853 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
3854 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
3855 keyword in a "defaults" section.
3856
3857 See also : "enabled"
3858
3859
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003860dispatch <address>:<port>
3861 Set a default server address
3862 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3863 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003864 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003865
3866 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
3867 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
3868 during start-up.
3869
3870 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
3871 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
3872 possible with normal servers.
3873
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02003874 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003875 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
3876 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
3877 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
3878 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
3879
3880 See also : "server"
3881
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003882
3883dynamic-cookie-key <string>
3884 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
3885 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3886 yes | no | yes | yes
3887 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
3888
3889 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003890 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003891 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
3892 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003893 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003894 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003895
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003896enabled
3897 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3898 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3899 yes | yes | yes | yes
3900 Arguments : none
3901
3902 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
3903 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
3904
3905 See also : "disabled"
3906
3907
3908errorfile <code> <file>
3909 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3910 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3911 yes | yes | yes | yes
3912 Arguments :
3913 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02003914 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
3915 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003916
3917 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003918 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003919 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003920 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3921 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003922
3923 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3924 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3925 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3926
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003927 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3928
Christopher Faulet70170672020-05-18 17:42:48 +02003929 The files are parsed when HAProxy starts and must be valid according to the
3930 HTTP specification. They should not exceed the configured buffer size
3931 (BUFSIZE), which generally is 16 kB, otherwise an internal error will be
3932 returned. It is also wise not to put any reference to local contents
3933 (e.g. images) in order to avoid loops between the client and HAProxy when all
3934 servers are down, causing an error to be returned instead of an
3935 image. Finally, The response cannot exceed (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite)
3936 so that "http-after-response" rules still have room to operate (see
3937 "tune.maxrewrite").
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003938
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003939 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
3940 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
3941 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003942 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003943 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
3944
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02003945 See also : "http-error", "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003946
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003947 Example :
3948 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003949 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003950 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
3951 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
3952
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003953
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003954errorfiles <name> [<code> ...]
3955 Import, fully or partially, the error files defined in the <name> http-errors
3956 section.
3957 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3958 yes | yes | yes | yes
3959 Arguments :
3960 <name> is the name of an existing http-errors section.
3961
3962 <code> is a HTTP status code. Several status code may be listed.
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02003963 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes 200, 400, 401,
3964 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003965
3966 Errors defined in the http-errors section with the name <name> are imported
3967 in the current proxy. If no status code is specified, all error files of the
3968 http-errors section are imported. Otherwise, only error files associated to
3969 the listed status code are imported. Those error files override the already
3970 defined custom errors for the proxy. And they may be overridden by following
3971 ones. Fonctionnly, it is exactly the same than declaring all error files by
3972 hand using "errorfile" directives.
3973
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02003974 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302" ,
3975 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003976
3977 Example :
3978 errorfiles generic
3979 errorfiles site-1 403 404
3980
3981
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003982errorloc <code> <url>
3983errorloc302 <code> <url>
3984 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3985 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3986 yes | yes | yes | yes
3987 Arguments :
3988 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02003989 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
3990 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003991
3992 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3993 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3994 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3995 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003996 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003997
3998 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3999 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4000 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4001
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004002 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4003
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004004 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
4005 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
4006 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
4007 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004008 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004009 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
4010 request.
4011
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004012 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004013
4014
4015errorloc303 <code> <url>
4016 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4017 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4018 yes | yes | yes | yes
4019 Arguments :
4020 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004021 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
4022 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004023
4024 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4025 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4026 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4027 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004028 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004029
4030 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4031 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4032 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4033
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004034 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4035
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004036 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
4037 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
4038 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
4039 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004040 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004041
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004042 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004043
4044
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004045email-alert from <emailaddr>
4046 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004047 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004048 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4049 yes | yes | yes | yes
4050
4051 Arguments :
4052
4053 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
4054
4055 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4056 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4057
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004058 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02004059 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
4060 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004061
4062
4063email-alert level <level>
4064 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
4065 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
4066 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4067 yes | yes | yes | yes
4068
4069 Arguments :
4070
4071 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
4072 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
4073 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
4074
4075 By default level is alert
4076
4077 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4078 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4079 for the proxy.
4080
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09004081 Alerts are sent when :
4082
4083 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
4084 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
4085 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
4086 is notice or lower
4087 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
4088 and a health check status update occurs
4089
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004090 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
4091 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004092 section 3.6 about mailers.
4093
4094
4095email-alert mailers <mailersect>
4096 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
4097 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4098 yes | yes | yes | yes
4099
4100 Arguments :
4101
4102 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
4103
4104 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
4105 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4106
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004107 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
4108 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004109
4110
4111email-alert myhostname <hostname>
4112 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
4113 mailers.
4114 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4115 yes | yes | yes | yes
4116
4117 Arguments :
4118
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01004119 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004120
4121 By default the systems hostname is used.
4122
4123 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4124 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4125 for the proxy.
4126
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004127 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
4128 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004129
4130
4131email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004132 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004133 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
4134 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4135 yes | yes | yes | yes
4136
4137 Arguments :
4138
4139 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
4140
4141 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4142 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4143
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004144 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004145 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
4146
4147
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004148force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
4149 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
4150 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01004151 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004152
4153 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
4154 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
4155 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
4156 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
4157 marked down for maintenance operations.
4158
4159 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
4160 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
4161 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
4162 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
4163 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
4164 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
4165 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
4166 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
4167 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
4168
4169 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
4170 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
4171 is used.
4172
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004173 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02004174 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004175
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004176
4177filter <name> [param*]
4178 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
4179 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4180 no | yes | yes | yes
4181 Arguments :
4182 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
4183 referenced in section 9.
4184
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004185 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004186 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004187 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
4188 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004189
4190 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
4191 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
4192
4193 Example:
4194 listen
4195 bind *:80
4196
4197 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
4198 filter compression
4199 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
4200
4201 compression algo gzip
4202 compression offload
4203
4204 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
4205
4206 See also : section 9.
4207
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004208
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004209fullconn <conns>
4210 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
4211 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4212 yes | no | yes | yes
4213 Arguments :
4214 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
4215 servers use the maximal number of connections.
4216
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004217 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004218 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004219 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004220 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
4221 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
4222 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
4223 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
4224 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004225 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004226
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02004227 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
4228 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01004229 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
4230 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
4231 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02004232
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004233 Example :
4234 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
4235 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
4236 # connections.
4237 backend dynamic
4238 fullconn 10000
4239 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
4240 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
4241
4242 See also : "maxconn", "server"
4243
4244
4245grace <time>
4246 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
4247 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01004248 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004249 Arguments :
4250 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
4251 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
4252 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
4253
4254 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
4255 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004256 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004257 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
4258
4259 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
4260 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
4261 simplify it.
4262
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004263
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004264hash-balance-factor <factor>
4265 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
4266 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4267 yes | no | no | yes
4268 Arguments :
4269 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
4270 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01004271 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004272
4273 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
4274 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
4275 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
4276 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
4277 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
4278 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
4279 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
4280
4281 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
4282 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
4283 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
4284 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
4285 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
4286
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02004287 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
4288 consistent hashing mechanism.
4289
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004290 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
4291
4292
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004293hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004294 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
4295 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4296 yes | no | yes | yes
4297 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004298 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
4299 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004300
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004301 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
4302 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
4303 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
4304 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
4305 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
4306 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
4307 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
4308 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
4309 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
4310 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01004311
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004312 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
4313 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
4314 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
4315 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
4316 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
4317 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
4318 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
4319 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
4320 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
4321 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
4322 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
4323 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
4324 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004325 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
4326 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004327
4328 <function> is the hash function to be used :
4329
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004330 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004331 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
4332 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
4333 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004334 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
4335 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
4336 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004337
4338 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
4339 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004340 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
4341 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
4342 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
4343 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
4344
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01004345 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
4346 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
4347 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
4348 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
4349 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
4350 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
4351 parameter.
4352
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01004353 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
4354 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
4355 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
4356 used on strings.
4357
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004358 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
4359
4360 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
4361 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
4362 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
4363 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
4364 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
4365 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
4366 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
4367 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
4368 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
4369 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
4370 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
4371 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004372
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004373 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
4374 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
4375 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004376
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004377 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004378
4379
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004380http-after-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4381 Access control for all Layer 7 responses (server, applet/service and internal
4382 ones).
4383
4384 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4385 no | yes | yes | yes
4386
4387 The http-after-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer
4388 7 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they
4389 are met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4390 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4391 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4392 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4393
4394 Unlike http-response rules, these ones are applied on all responses, the
4395 server ones but also to all responses generated by HAProxy. These rules are
4396 evaluated at the end of the responses analysis, before the data forwarding.
4397
4398 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4399 below.
4400
4401 There is no limit to the number of http-after-response statements per
4402 instance.
4403
4404 Example:
4405 http-after-response set-header Strict-Transport-Security "max-age=31536000"
4406 http-after-response set-header Cache-Control "no-store,no-cache,private"
4407 http-after-response set-header Pragma "no-cache"
4408
4409http-after-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4410
4411 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
4412 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
4413 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
4414 example, or to pass some internal information.
4415 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4416 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
4417 the resulting header from a previous rule.
4418
4419http-after-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4420
4421 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
4422 No further "http-after-response" rules are evaluated.
4423
4424http-after-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4425
4426 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
4427
4428http-after-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4429 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4430
4431 This works like "http-response replace-header".
4432
4433 Example:
4434 http-after-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
4435
4436 # applied to:
4437 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4438
4439 # outputs:
4440 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4441
4442 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
4443
4444http-after-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4445 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4446
4447 This works like "http-response replace-value".
4448
4449 Example:
4450 http-after-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
4451
4452 # applied to:
4453 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
4454
4455 # outputs:
4456 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
4457
4458http-after-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4459
4460 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
4461 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
4462 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
4463
4464http-after-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
4465 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4466
4467 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
4468 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
4469 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
4470 fallback.
4471
4472 Example:
4473 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
4474 http-response set-status 431
4475 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
4476 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down"
4477
4478http-after-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4479
4480 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4481 inline.
4482
4483 Arguments:
4484 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4485 scope. The scopes allowed are:
4486 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
4487 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4488 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
4489 (request and response)
4490 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
4491 processing
4492 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4493 processing
4494 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4495 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
4496 and '_'.
4497
4498 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4499 followed by some converters.
4500
4501 Example:
4502 http-after-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
4503
4504http-after-response strict-mode { on | off }
4505
4506 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
4507 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
4508 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
4509 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
4510 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05004511 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004512 processing.
4513
4514 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
4515 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
4516 the bacnkend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
4517 rules evaluation.
4518
4519http-after-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4520
4521 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-after-response set-var" for
4522 details about <var-name>.
4523
4524 Example:
4525 http-after-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
4526
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004527
4528http-check comment <string>
4529 Defines a comment for the following the http-check rule, reported in logs if
4530 it fails.
4531 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4532 yes | no | yes | yes
4533
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004534 Arguments :
4535 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following http-check
4536 rule fails.
4537
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004538 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
4539 user-friendly error reporting.
4540
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004541 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check conncet", "http-check send" and
4542 "http-check expect".
4543
4544
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004545http-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy]
4546 [via-socks4] [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02004547 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004548 Opens a new connection to perform an HTTP health check
4549 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4550 yes | no | yes | yes
4551
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004552 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004553 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
4554
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004555 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
4556 checks. The server options are used only if not redifined.
4557
4558 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
4559 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
4560 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
4561 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
4562
4563 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
4564
4565 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
4566
4567 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
4568
4569 ssl opens a ciphered connection
4570
4571 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
4572
4573 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
4574 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
4575 for instance: "h2,http/1.1". If it is not set, the server ALPN
4576 is used.
4577
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02004578 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
4579 It must be an HTTP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
4580 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
4581 haproxy -vv.
4582
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004583 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
4584
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004585 Just like tcp-check health checks, it is possible to configure the connection
4586 to use to perform HTTP health check. This directive should also be used to
4587 describe a scenario involving several request/response exchanges, possibly on
4588 different ports or with different servers.
4589
4590 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
4591 directive, then the first step of the http-check sequence must be to specify
4592 the port with a "http-check connect".
4593
4594 In an http-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
4595 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
4596 do.
4597
4598 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
4599 unset-var or comment rules.
4600
4601 Examples :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004602 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
4603 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
4604 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
4605 option httpchk
4606
4607 http-check connect
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02004608 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02004609 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004610 http-check connect port 443 ssl sni haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02004611 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02004612 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004613
4614 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
4615
4616 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send", "http-check expect"
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004617
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004618
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004619http-check disable-on-404
4620 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
4621 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004622 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004623 Arguments : none
4624
4625 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
4626 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
4627 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
4628 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
4629 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
4630 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
4631 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
4632 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004633 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
4634 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
4635 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
4636
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004637 See also : "option httpchk" and "http-check expect".
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004638
4639
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004640http-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004641 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
4642 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
4643 [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004644 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004645 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02004646 yes | no | yes | yes
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004647
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004648 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004649 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
4650
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004651 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
4652 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
4653 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
4654 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
4655 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
4656 incomplete. If an exact string is used, the minimum between the
4657 string length and this parameter is used. This parameter is
4658 ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule does not match,
4659 the check will wait for more data. If set to 0, the evaluation
4660 result is always conclusive.
4661
4662 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
4663 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
4664 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02004665 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
4666 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
4667 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, for
4668 example 404 with disable-on-404
4669 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
4670 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
4671 By default "L7OK" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004672
4673 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
4674 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02004675 "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are supported :
4676 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
4677 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
4678 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
4679 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
4680 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004681
4682 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
4683 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02004684 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
4685 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
4686 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
4687 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004688 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
4689
4690 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
4691 informational message reported in logs if the expect
4692 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
4693 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
4694
4695 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
4696 informational message reported in logs if an error
4697 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
4698 log-format string.
4699
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004700 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02004701 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus", "hdr",
4702 "fhdr", "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004703 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
4704 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
4705 details on the supported keywords.
4706
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02004707 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string, a regular
4708 expression or a more complex pattern with several arguments. If
4709 the string pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped with the
4710 usual backslash ('\').
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004711
4712 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
4713 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
4714 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
4715 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
4716 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
4717
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02004718 status <codes> : test the status codes found parsing <codes> string. it
4719 must be a comma-separated list of status codes or range
4720 codes. A health check response will be considered as
4721 valid if the response's status code matches any status
4722 code or is inside any range of the list. If the "status"
4723 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
4724 considered invalid if the status code matches.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004725
4726 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004727 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004728 response's status code matches the expression. If the
4729 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4730 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4731 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
4732
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02004733 hdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
4734 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02004735 test the specified header pattern on the HTTP response
4736 headers. The name pattern is mandatory but the value
4737 pattern is optional. If not specified, only the header
4738 presence is verified. <meth> is the matching method,
4739 applied on the header name or the header value. Supported
4740 matching methods are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix
4741 match), "end" (suffix match), "sub" (substring match) or
4742 "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02004743 method is used. If the "name-lf" parameter is used,
4744 <name> is evaluated as a log-format string. If "value-lf"
4745 parameter is used, <value> is evaluated as a log-format
4746 string. These parameters cannot be used with the regex
4747 matching method. Finally, the header value is considered
4748 as comma-separated list. Note that matchings are case
4749 insensitive on the header names.
4750
4751 fhdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
4752 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
4753 test the specified full header pattern on the HTTP
4754 response headers. It does exactly the same than "hdr"
4755 keyword, except the full header value is tested, commas
4756 are not considered as delimiters.
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02004757
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004758 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004759 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004760 response's body contains this exact string. If the
4761 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4762 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
4763 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
4764 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004765 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004766 trace).
4767
4768 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004769 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004770 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
4771 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
4772 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
4773 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
4774 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004775 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004776
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +02004777 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the HTTP response body.
4778 A health check response will be considered valid if the
4779 response's body contains the string resulting of the
4780 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
4781 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
4782 considered invalid if the body contains the string.
4783
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004784 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
4785 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
4786 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
4787 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
4788 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
4789 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
4790 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
4791 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
4792
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004793 In an http-check ruleset, the last expect rule may be implicit. If no expect
4794 rule is specified after the last "http-check send", an implicit expect rule
4795 is defined to match on 2xx or 3xx status codes. It means this rule is also
4796 defined if there is no "http-check" rule at all, when only "option httpchk"
4797 is set.
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01004798
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004799 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
4800 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
4801
4802 Examples :
4803 # only accept status 200 as valid
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02004804 http-check expect status 200,201,300-310
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004805
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02004806 # be sure a sessid coookie is set
4807 http-check expect header name "set-cookie" value -m beg "sessid="
4808
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004809 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004810 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004811
4812 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004813 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004814
4815 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03004816 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004817
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004818 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check disable-on-404"
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004819 and "http-check send".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004820
4821
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02004822http-check send [meth <method>] [{ uri <uri> | uri-lf <fmt> }>] [ver <version>]
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02004823 [hdr <name> <fmt>]* [{ body <string> | body-lf <fmt> }]
4824 [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02004825 Add a possible list of headers and/or a body to the request sent during HTTP
4826 health checks.
4827 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4828 yes | no | yes | yes
4829 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004830 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
4831
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004832 meth <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not
4833 set, the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires
4834 low server processing and is easy to filter out from the
4835 logs. Any method may be used, though it is not recommended
4836 to invent non-standard ones.
4837
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02004838 uri <uri> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
4839 to the string <uri>. It defaults to "/" which is accessible
4840 by default on almost any server, but may be changed to any
4841 other URI. Query strings are permitted.
4842
4843 uri-lf <fmt> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
4844 using the log-format string <fmt>. It defaults to "/" which
4845 is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
4846 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02004847
Christopher Faulet907701b2020-04-28 09:37:00 +02004848 ver <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004849 "HTTP/1.0" but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP
4850 1.0, so turningit to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that
4851 the Host field is mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "hdr" argument
4852 to add it.
4853
4854 hdr <name> <fmt> adds the HTTP header field whose name is specified in
4855 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt>, which follows
4856 to the log-format rules.
4857
4858 body <string> add the body defined by <string> to the request sent during
4859 HTTP health checks. If defined, the "Content-Length" header
4860 is thus automatically added to the request.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02004861
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02004862 body-lf <fmt> add the body defined by the log-format string <fmt> to the
4863 request sent during HTTP health checks. If defined, the
4864 "Content-Length" header is thus automatically added to the
4865 request.
4866
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02004867 In addition to the request line defined by the "option httpchk" directive,
4868 this one is the valid way to add some headers and optionally a body to the
4869 request sent during HTTP health checks. If a body is defined, the associate
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02004870 "Content-Length" header is automatically added. Thus, this header or
4871 "Transfer-encoding" header should not be present in the request provided by
4872 "http-check send". If so, it will be ignored. The old trick consisting to add
4873 headers after the version string on the "option httpchk" line is now
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02004874 deprecated. Note also the "Connection: close" header is still added if a
4875 "http-check expect" direcive is defined independently of this directive, just
4876 like the state header if the directive "http-check send-state" is defined.
4877
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004878 Also "http-check send" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
4879 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02004880 header should not be present in the request provided by "http-check send". If
4881 so, it will be ignored.
4882
4883 Note that the Host header and the request authority, when both defined, are
4884 automatically synchronized. It means when the HTTP request is sent, when a
4885 Host is inserted in the request, the request authority is accordingly
4886 updated. Thus, don't be surprised if the Host header value overwrites the
4887 configured request authority.
4888
4889 Note also for now, no Host header is automatically added in HTTP/1.1 or above
4890 requests. You should add it explicitly.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004891
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004892 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send-state" and "http-check expect".
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02004893
4894
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004895http-check send-state
4896 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
4897 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4898 yes | no | yes | yes
4899 Arguments : none
4900
4901 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
4902 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
4903 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
4904 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
4905 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
4906
4907 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
4908 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
4909 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
4910 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
4911 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08004912 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
4913 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
4914 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4915
4916 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
4917 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
4918 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4919
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004920 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
4921 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
4922 checked in multiple backends.
4923
4924 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
4925 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
4926
4927 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
4928 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
4929 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
4930 one fails.
4931
4932 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
4933 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
4934 connections on all servers of the same backend.
4935
4936 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
4937 server's queue.
4938
4939 Example of a header received by the application server :
4940 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
4941 scur=13/22; qcur=0
4942
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004943 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404" and
4944 "http-check send".
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004945
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004946
4947http-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004948 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004949 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4950 yes | no | yes | yes
4951
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004952 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004953 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4954 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
4955 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
4956 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
4957 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
4958 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4959 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
4960 and '-'.
4961
4962 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
4963
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004964 Examples :
4965 http-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004966
4967
4968http-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004969 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004970 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4971 yes | no | yes | yes
4972
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004973 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004974 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4975 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
4976 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
4977 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
4978 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
4979 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4980 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
4981 and '-'.
4982
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004983 Examples :
4984 http-check unset-var(check.port)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004985
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004986
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004987http-error status <code> [content-type <type>]
4988 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
4989 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
4990 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
4991 Defines a custom error message to use instead of errors generated by HAProxy.
4992 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4993 yes | yes | yes | yes
4994 Arguments :
4995 staus <code> is the HTTP status code. It must be specified.
4996 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004997 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 425, 429,
4998 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004999
5000 content-type <type> is the response content type, for instance
5001 "text/plain". This parameter is ignored and should be
5002 omitted when an errorfile is configured or when the
5003 payload is empty. Otherwise, it must be defined.
5004
5005 default-errorfiles Reset the previously defined error message for current
5006 proxy for the status <code>. If used on a backend, the
5007 frontend error message is used, if defined. If used on
5008 a frontend, the default error message is used.
5009
5010 errorfile <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response.
5011 It is recommended to follow the common practice of
5012 appending ".http" to the filename so that people do
5013 not confuse the response with HTML error pages, and to
5014 use absolute paths, since files are read before any
5015 chroot is performed.
5016
5017 errorfiles <name> designates the http-errors section to use to import
5018 the error message with the status code <code>. If no
5019 such message is found, the proxy's error messages are
5020 considered.
5021
5022 file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5023 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5024 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5025 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5026 considered as a raw string.
5027
5028 string <str> specifies the raw string to use as response payload.
5029 The content-type must always be set as argument to
5030 "content-type".
5031
5032 lf-file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5033 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5034 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5035 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5036 evaluated as a log-format string.
5037
5038 lf-string <str> specifies the log-format string to use as response
5039 payload. The content-type must always be set as
5040 argument to "content-type".
5041
5042 hdr <name> <fmt> adds to the response the HTTP header field whose name
5043 is specified in <name> and whose value is defined by
5044 <fmt>, which follows to the log-format rules.
5045 This parameter is ignored if an errorfile is used.
5046
5047 This directive may be used instead of "errorfile", to define a custom error
5048 message. As "errorfile" directive, it is used for errors detected and
5049 returned by HAProxy. If an errorfile is defined, it is parsed when HAProxy
5050 starts and must be valid according to the HTTP standards. The generated
5051 response must not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFFSIZE), otherwise an
5052 internal error will be returned. Finally, if you consider to use some
5053 http-after-response rules to rewrite these errors, the reserved buffer space
5054 should be available (see "tune.maxrewrite").
5055
5056 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
5057 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
5058 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running.
5059
5060 See also : "errorfile", "errorfiles", "errorloc", "errorloc302",
5061 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
5062
5063
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005064http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005065 Access control for Layer 7 requests
5066
5067 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5068 no | yes | yes | yes
5069
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005070 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
5071 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
5072 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5073 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5074 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005075
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005076 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5077 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005078
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005079 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005080
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005081 Example:
5082 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
5083 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
5084 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005085
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005086 http-request allow if nagios
5087 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
5088 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
5089 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01005090
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005091 Example:
5092 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
5093 acl add path /addacl
5094 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005095
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005096 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005097
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005098 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
5099 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02005100
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005101 Example:
5102 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
5103 acl setmap path /setmap
5104 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005105
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005106 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005107
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005108 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
5109 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005110
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005111 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
5112 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005113
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005114http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005115
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005116 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5117 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5118 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5119 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
5120 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
5121 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5122 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5123 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005124
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005125http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005126
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005127 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
5128 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
5129 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
5130 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
5131 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
5132 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
5133 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
5134 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005135
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005136http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005137
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005138 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
5139 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005140
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005141
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005142http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005143
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005144 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
5145 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
5146 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
5147 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
5148 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005149
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02005150 The corresponding proxy's error message is used. It may be customized using
5151 an "errorfile" or an "http-error" directive. For 401 responses, all
5152 occurrences of the WWW-Authenticate header are removed and replaced by a new
5153 one with a basic authentication challenge for realm "<realm>". For 407
5154 responses, the same is done on the Proxy-Authenticate header. If the error
5155 message must not be altered, consider to use "http-request return" rule
5156 instead.
5157
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005158 Example:
5159 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
5160 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005161
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02005162http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005163
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02005164 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005165
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005166http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
5167 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005168
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005169 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
5170 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
5171 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
5172 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
5173 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
5174 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
5175 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
5176 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
5177 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005178
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005179 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
5180 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
5181 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01005182 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
5183
5184 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
5185 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
5186 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
5187 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005188
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005189http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005190
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005191 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5192 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5193 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5194 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5195 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5196 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005197
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005198http-request del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02005199
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005200 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02005201
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005202http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02005203
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005204 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5205 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5206 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5207 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5208 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
5209 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02005210
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005211http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5212http-request deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
5213 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5214 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5215 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5216 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04005217
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005218 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request.
5219 By default an HTTP 403 error is returned. But the response may be customized
5220 using same syntax than "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request
5221 return" for details. For compatiblity purpose, when no argument is defined,
5222 or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
5223 "http-request deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
5224 "http-request deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005225 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005226 See also "http-request return".
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04005227
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02005228http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5229 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
5230 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
5231 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
5232
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01005233http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
5234
5235 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
5236 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
5237 pointed by <resolvers>.
5238 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
5239 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
5240 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
5241 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
5242 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
5243 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
5244 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
5245 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
5246 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
5247 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
5248 to 0.0.0.0.
5249
5250 Example:
5251 resolvers mydns
5252 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
5253 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
5254 timeout retry 1s
5255 hold valid 10s
5256 hold nx 3s
5257 hold other 3s
5258 hold obsolete 0s
5259 accepted_payload_size 8192
5260
5261 frontend fe
5262 bind 10.42.0.1:80
5263 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
5264 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
5265
5266 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
5267 # which mean DNS resolution error
5268 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
5269
5270 default_backend be
5271
5272 backend b_503
5273 # dummy backend used to return 503.
5274 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
5275 # 503 error page to end users
5276
5277 backend be
5278 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
5279 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
5280 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
5281 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
5282 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
5283
5284 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
5285 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
5286
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01005287http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5288
5289 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
5290 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
5291 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
5292 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01005293 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
5294 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01005295
5296 See RFC 8297 for more information.
5297
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005298http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005299
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005300 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
5301 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
5302 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
5303 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
5304 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005305
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005306http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005307
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005308 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
5309 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
5310 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
5311 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005312
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005313http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5314 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02005315
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005316 This matches the value of all occurrences of header field <name> against
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005317 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
5318 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
5319 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
5320 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
5321 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02005322
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005323 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
5324 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
5325 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
5326 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
5327 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01005328
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005329 Example:
5330 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
5331
5332 # applied to:
5333 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
5334
5335 # outputs:
5336 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
5337
5338 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005339
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005340 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
5341
5342 # applied to:
5343 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005344
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005345 # outputs:
5346 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005347
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01005348http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5349 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5350
5351 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
5352 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
5353 after an optional scheme+authority. It does contain the query string if any
5354 is present. The replacement does not modify the scheme nor authority.
5355
5356 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
5357 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
5358 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
5359
5360 Example:
5361 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
5362 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
5363
5364 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
5365 http-request replace-path ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
5366
5367 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
5368 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
5369 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
5370 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
5371
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005372http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5373 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5374
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005375 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
5376 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
5377 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
5378 against.
5379
5380 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
5381 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
5382 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005383
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01005384 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
5385 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
5386 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
5387 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
5388 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
5389 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
5390 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
5391 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
5392 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01005393 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
5394 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005395
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01005396 Example:
5397 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
5398 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005399
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01005400 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
5401 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005402
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005403http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5404 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005405
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005406 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
5407 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
5408 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
5409 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005410
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005411 Example:
5412 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02005413
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005414 # applied to:
5415 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02005416
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005417 # outputs:
5418 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01005419
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005420http-request return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
5421 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5422 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01005423 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005424 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5425
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005426 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005427 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
5428 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
5429 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itselft may
5430 be defined. If can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005431 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005432 are followed to create the response :
5433
5434 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
5435 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
5436 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
5437 ignored.
5438
5439 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
5440 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
5441 status code handled by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425,
5442 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is
5443 ignored.
5444
5445 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
5446 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
5447 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
5448 by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and
5449 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
5450
5451 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
5452 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
5453 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
5454 must be one of the status code handled by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
5455 408, 410, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument,
5456 if any, is ignored.
5457
5458 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
5459 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
5460 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
5461 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
5462 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
5463 as a raw content.
5464
5465 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
5466 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
5467 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
5468 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
5469 considered as a raw string.
5470
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01005471 When the response is not based an errorfile, it is possible to appends HTTP
5472 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
5473 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
5474 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
5475
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005476 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
5477 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
5478 reserved to the headers rewritting should also be free.
5479
5480 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
5481
5482 Example:
5483 http-request return errorfile /etc/haproy/errorfiles/200.http \
5484 if { path /ping }
5485
5486 http-request return content-type image/x-icon file /var/www/favicon.ico \
5487 if { path /favicon.ico }
5488
5489 http-request return status 403 content-type text/plain \
5490 lf-string "Access denied. IP %[src] is blacklisted." \
5491 if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
5492
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005493http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5494http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005495
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005496 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
5497 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
5498 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005499
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01005500http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
5501 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005502
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01005503 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
5504 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
5505 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
5506 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005507
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005508http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005509
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005510 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
5511 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
5512 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
5513 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
5514 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005515
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005516 Arguments:
5517 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
5518 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005519
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005520 Example:
5521 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
5522 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005523
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005524 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
5525 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005526
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005527http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005528
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005529 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
5530 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
5531 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005532
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005533 Arguments:
5534 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5535 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005536
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005537 Example:
5538 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
5539 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005540
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005541 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
5542 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
5543 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005544
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005545http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005546
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005547 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
5548 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
5549 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
5550 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
5551 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005552
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005553 Example:
5554 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
5555 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
5556 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
5557 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
5558 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
5559 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
5560 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
5561 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
5562 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005563
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005564http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005565
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005566 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
5567 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
5568 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
5569 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
5570 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005571
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005572http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
5573 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005574
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005575 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5576 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5577 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
5578 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
5579 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
5580 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
5581 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
5582 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
5583 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005584
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005585http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005586
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005587 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
5588 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
5589 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
5590 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
5591 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
5592 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
5593 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02005594
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005595http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005596
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005597 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
5598 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
5599 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005600
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005601http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005602
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005603 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
5604 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
5605 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
5606 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
5607 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
5608 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
5609 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
5610 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005611
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005612http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02005613
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005614 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
5615 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
5616 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
5617 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
5618 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
5619 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02005620
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005621 Example :
5622 # prepend the host name before the path
5623 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005624
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005625http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02005626
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005627 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
5628 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
5629 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
5630 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
5631 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005632
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005633http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005634
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005635 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
5636 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
5637 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
5638 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
5639 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
5640 values have higher priority.
5641 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
5642 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
5643 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
5644 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
5645 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005646
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005647http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005648
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005649 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
5650 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
5651 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
5652 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
5653 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
5654 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
5655 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08005656
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005657 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005658
5659 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005660 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
5661 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005662
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005663http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5664 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
5665 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
5666 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02005667 privacy. All subsequent calls to "src" fetch will return this value
5668 (see example).
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005669
5670 Arguments :
5671 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
5672 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005673
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02005674 See also "option forwardfor".
5675
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01005676 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005677 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
5678 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
5679
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02005680 # After the masking this will track connections
5681 # based on the IP address with the last byte zeroed out.
5682 http-request track-sc0 src
5683
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005684 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
5685 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
5686
5687http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5688
5689 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
5690 expression.
5691
5692 Arguments:
5693 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
5694 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005695
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005696 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005697 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
5698 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
5699
5700 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
5701 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
5702 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
5703
5704http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5705
5706 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
5707 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
5708 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
5709 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
5710 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
5711 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
5712 information from the request.
5713
5714 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
5715
5716http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5717
5718 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
5719 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
5720 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
5721 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
5722 path and the query string.
5723 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
5724
5725http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5726
5727 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5728 inline.
5729
5730 Arguments:
5731 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5732 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5733 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5734 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5735 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5736 (request and response)
5737 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5738 processing
5739 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5740 processing
5741 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5742 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
5743 and '_'.
5744
5745 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5746 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005747
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005748 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005749 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005750
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005751http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
5752 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005753
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005754 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
5755 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
5756 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
5757 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
5758 agent name must be used.
5759
5760 Arguments:
5761 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
5762
5763 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
5764 configuration.
5765
5766http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5767
5768 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
5769 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
5770 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
5771 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
5772 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
5773 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
5774 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
5775 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
5776 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
5777 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
5778 action.
5779 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
5780 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
5781 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
5782 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
5783 you fully understand how it works.
5784
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005785http-request strict-mode { on | off }
5786
5787 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
5788 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
5789 performing a rewrite on the requests. When the strict mode is enabled, any
5790 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
5791 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005792 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the request
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005793 processing.
5794
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01005795 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005796 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
5797 the frontend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the backend
5798 rules evaluation.
5799
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005800http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5801http-request tarpit [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
5802 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5803 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5804 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5805 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005806
5807 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
5808 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
5809 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005810 is still connected, a response is returned so that the client does not
5811 suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT". The goal of
5812 the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when they're limited
5813 on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very efficient against very
5814 dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load on firewalls compared to
5815 a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly" developed robots, it can make
5816 things worse by forcing haproxy and the front firewall to support insane
5817 number of concurrent connections. By default an HTTP error 500 is returned.
5818 But the response may be customized using same syntax than
5819 "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request return" for details.
5820 For compatiblity purpose, when no argument is defined, or only "deny_status",
5821 the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
5822 "http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
5823 "http-request tarpit [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
5824 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
5825 See also "http-request return" and "http-request silent-drop".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005826
5827http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5828http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5829http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5830
5831 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
5832 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
5833 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
5834 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
5835 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first
5836 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
5837 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
5838 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
5839 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
5840 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
5841 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
5842 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
5843
5844 Arguments :
5845 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
5846 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
5847 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
5848 select which table entry to update the counters.
5849
5850 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
5851 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
5852 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
5853 that table until the session ends.
5854
5855 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
5856 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
5857 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
5858 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
5859 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
5860 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
5861 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
5862 useful information.
5863
5864 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
5865 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
5866 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
5867 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
5868 checks that make use of it.
5869
5870http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5871
5872 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005873
5874 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005875 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005876
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01005877http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5878
5879 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
5880 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
5881 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
5882 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
5883 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
5884 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
5885
5886 Arguments :
5887 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
5888
5889 Example:
5890 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
5891
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005892http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005893
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005894 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
5895 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
5896 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005897
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005898
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005899http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005900 Access control for Layer 7 responses
5901
5902 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5903 no | yes | yes | yes
5904
5905 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
5906 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
5907 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5908 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5909 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
5910 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
5911
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005912 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5913 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005914
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005915 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005916
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005917 Example:
5918 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02005919
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005920 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005921
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005922 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
5923 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005924
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005925 Example:
5926 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005927
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005928 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005929
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005930 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
5931 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005932
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005933 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
5934 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005935
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005936http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005937
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005938 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5939 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5940 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5941 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
5942 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
5943 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5944 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5945 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005946
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005947http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005948
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005949 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
5950 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
5951 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
5952 example, or to pass some internal information.
5953 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
5954 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
5955 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005956
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005957http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005958
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005959 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
5960 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005961
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02005962http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005963
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02005964 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005965
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005966http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005967
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005968 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
5969 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
5970 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
5971 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
5972 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
5973 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
5974 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005975
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005976 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
5977 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
5978 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
5979 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
5980 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01005981
5982 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
5983 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
5984 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
5985 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005986
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005987http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005988
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005989 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5990 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5991 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5992 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5993 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5994 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02005995
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005996http-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02005997
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005998 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02005999
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006000http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02006001
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006002 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6003 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6004 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6005 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6006 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
6007 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006008
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006009http-response deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6010http-response deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6011 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6012 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6013 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6014 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006015
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006016 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response.
6017 By default an HTTP 502 error is returned. But the response may be customized
6018 using same syntax than "http-response return" rules. Thus, see
6019 "http-response return" for details. For compatiblity purpose, when no
6020 argument is defined, or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles"
6021 is implied. It means "http-response deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias
6022 of "http-response deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01006023 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006024 See also "http-response return".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006025
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006026http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006027
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006028 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
6029 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
6030 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
6031 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
6032 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
6033 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02006034
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006035http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
6036 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02006037
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006038 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
6039 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01006040
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006041 Example:
6042 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02006043
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006044 # applied to:
6045 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006046
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006047 # outputs:
6048 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006049
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006050 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006051
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006052http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
6053 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006054
Tim Duesterhus6bd909b2020-01-17 15:53:18 +01006055 This works like "http-request replace-value" except that it works on the
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006056 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006057
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006058 Example:
6059 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006060
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006061 # applied to:
6062 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006063
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006064 # outputs:
6065 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006066
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006067http-response return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
6068 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6069 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006070 [ hdr <name> <value> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006071 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6072
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006073 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006074 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
6075 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
6076 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itselft may
6077 be defined. If can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006078 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006079 are followed to create the response :
6080
6081 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
6082 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
6083 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
6084 ignored.
6085
6086 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
6087 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
6088 status code handled by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425,
6089 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is
6090 ignored.
6091
6092 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
6093 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
6094 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
6095 by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and
6096 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
6097
6098 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
6099 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
6100 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
6101 must be one of the status code handled by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
6102 408, 410, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument,
6103 if any, is ignored.
6104
6105 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
6106 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
6107 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
6108 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
6109 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
6110 as a raw content.
6111
6112 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
6113 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
6114 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
6115 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
6116 considered as a raw string.
6117
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006118 When the response is not based an errorfile, it is possible to appends HTTP
6119 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
6120 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
6121 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
6122
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006123 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
6124 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
6125 reserved to the headers rewritting should also be free.
6126
6127 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
6128
6129 Example:
6130 http-response return errorfile /etc/haproy/errorfiles/200.http \
6131 if { status eq 404 }
6132
6133 http-response return content-type text/plain \
6134 string "This is the end !" \
6135 if { status eq 500 }
6136
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006137http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6138http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08006139
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006140 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
6141 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
6142 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02006143
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006144http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6145 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02006146
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006147 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
6148 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
6149 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
6150 evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01006151
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006152http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02006153
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006154 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
6155 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
6156 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
6157 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
6158 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006159
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006160 Arguments:
6161 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006162
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006163 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
6164 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006165
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006166http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006167
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006168 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
6169 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
6170 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006171
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006172http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6173
6174 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
6175 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
6176 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
6177 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
6178 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
6179
6180http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
6181
6182 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6183 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6184 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
6185 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
6186 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
6187 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
6188 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
6189 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
6190 be triggered by an HTTP response.
6191
6192http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6193
6194 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
6195 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
6196 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
6197 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
6198 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
6199 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
6200 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
6201
6202http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6203
6204 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
6205 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
6206 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
6207 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
6208 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
6209 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
6210 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
6211 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
6212
6213http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
6214 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6215
6216 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
6217 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
6218 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
6219 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006220
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006221 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006222 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
6223 http-response set-status 431
6224 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
6225 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006226
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006227http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006228
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006229 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
6230 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
6231 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
6232 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
6233 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
6234 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
6235 based on some information from the request.
6236
6237 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
6238
6239http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6240
6241 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
6242 inline.
6243
6244 Arguments:
6245 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6246 scope. The scopes allowed are:
6247 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
6248 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
6249 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
6250 (request and response)
6251 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
6252 processing
6253 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
6254 processing
6255 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6256 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
6257 and '_'.
6258
6259 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6260 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006261
6262 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006263 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006264
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006265http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006266
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006267 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
6268 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
6269 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
6270 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
6271 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
6272 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
6273 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
6274 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
6275 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
6276 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
6277 action.
6278 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
6279 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
6280 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
6281 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
6282 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006283
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006284http-response strict-mode { on | off }
6285
6286 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
6287 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
6288 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
6289 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
6290 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006291 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006292 processing.
6293
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01006294 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006295 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
6296 the bacnkend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
6297 rules evaluation.
6298
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006299http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6300http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6301http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006302
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006303 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
6304 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
6305 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
6306 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
6307 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
6308 supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
6309
6310http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6311
6312 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
6313 about <var-name>.
6314
6315 Example:
6316 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
6317
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02006318
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006319http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
6320 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
6321
6322 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6323 yes | no | yes | yes
6324
6325 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01006326 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
6327 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
6328 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006329
6330 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
6331
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01006332 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
6333 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
6334 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
6335 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
6336 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
6337 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
6338 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
6339 such an application could be an old haproxy using cookie
6340 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
6341 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006342
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01006343 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
6344 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
6345 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
6346 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
6347 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
6348 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
6349 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
6350 effects.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006351
6352 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
6353 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
6354 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
6355 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
6356 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
6357 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
6358 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
6359 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02006360 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006361 downsides of rare connection failures.
6362
6363 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
6364 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
6365 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
6366 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
6367 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
6368 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006369 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006370 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
6371 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
6372 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
6373 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
6374 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
6375
6376 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006377 connection properties and compatibility. Specifically :
6378 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependent value
6379 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006380
6381 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006382 and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006383
Lukas Tribusfd9b68c2018-10-27 20:06:59 +02006384 - connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying on the
6385 connection) like NTLM are detected, marked private and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006386
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01006387 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006388
6389 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
6390 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
6391 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
6392
6393 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
6394
6395
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006396http-send-name-header [<header>]
6397 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006398 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6399 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006400 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006401 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
6402
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02006403 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
6404 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
6405 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
6406 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
6407 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
6408 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
6409 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
6410 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
6411 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
6412 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
6413 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
6414 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
6415 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
6416 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
6417 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
6418 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006419
6420 See also : "server"
6421
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01006422id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02006423 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
6424 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6425 no | yes | yes | yes
6426 Arguments : none
6427
6428 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
6429 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
6430 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01006431
6432
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006433ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
6434 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
6435 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01006436 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006437
6438 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
6439 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
6440 and running).
6441
6442 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
6443 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
6444 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006445 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006446 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
6447
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006448 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
6449 "unless" condition is met.
6450
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03006451 Example:
6452 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
6453 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
6454 ignore-persist if url_static
6455
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006456 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
6457
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006458load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
6459 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
6460 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6461 yes | no | yes | yes
6462
6463 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
6464 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
6465 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006466 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006467 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
6468 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
6469 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
6470 over the stats socket and redirect output.
6471
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006472 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006473 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02006474 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006475
6476 Arguments:
6477 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
6478 named "server-state-file".
6479
6480 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
6481 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
6482 name is used as a file name.
6483
6484 none don't load any stat for this backend
6485
6486 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01006487 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
6488 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
6489 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006490 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01006491 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006492
6493 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
6494 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
6495
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006496 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006497
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006498 global
6499 stats socket /tmp/socket
6500 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006501
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006502 defaults
6503 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006504
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006505 backend bk
6506 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
6507 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006508
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006509
6510 Then one can run :
6511
6512 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
6513
6514 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
6515
6516 1
6517 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
6518 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
6519 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
6520
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006521 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006522
6523 global
6524 stats socket /tmp/socket
6525 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
6526
6527 defaults
6528 load-server-state-from-file local
6529
6530 backend bk
6531 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
6532 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
6533
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006534
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006535 Then one can run :
6536
6537 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
6538
6539 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
6540
6541 1
6542 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
6543 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
6544 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
6545
6546 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
6547 "show servers state"
6548
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006549
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006550log global
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02006551log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
6552 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02006553no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006554 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
6555 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6556 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02006557
6558 Prefix :
6559 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
6560 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
6561 prefix does not allow arguments.
6562
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006563 Arguments :
6564 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
6565 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
6566 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
6567 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
6568 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
6569 parameter.
6570
6571 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
6572 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
6573
6574 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
6575 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
6576 standard syslog port).
6577
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01006578 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
6579 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
6580 standard syslog port).
6581
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006582 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
6583 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
6584 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006585 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006586
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01006587 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
6588 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
6589 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
6590 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
6591 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
6592 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
6593 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
6594 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
6595 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
6596 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
6597 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
6598 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
6599 significantly slow haproxy down as non-blocking calls will be
6600 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
6601 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
6602 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006603 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
6604 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01006605
6606 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
6607 and "fd@2", see above.
6608
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02006609 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
6610 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
6611 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
6612 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
6613 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
6614 having the logs instantly available.
6615
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01006616 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
6617 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01006618
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02006619 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
6620 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
6621 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
6622 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
6623 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
6624 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
6625 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
6626 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
6627 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
6628 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006629 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02006630
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02006631 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
6632 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
6633 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
6634 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
6635 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
6636
6637 <sample_size>
6638 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
6639 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
6640 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
6641 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
6642 (see also <ranges> parameter).
6643
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01006644 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
6645 one of the following :
6646
6647 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
6648 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
6649
6650 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
6651 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
6652
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01006653 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
6654 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
6655 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
6656 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
6657 systemd logger consumes.
6658
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006659 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
6660 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
6661 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
6662 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
6663
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006664 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
6665
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01006666 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
6667 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
6668 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
6669
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006670 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
6671 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
6672 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
6673 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006674
6675 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
6676 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
6677 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02006678 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
6679 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
6680 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
6681 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
6682 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006683
6684 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
6685
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02006686 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
6687 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
6688 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01006689
6690 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
6691 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
6692 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
6693 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
6694
6695 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
6696 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006697
6698 Example :
6699 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006700 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
6701 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
6702 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02006703 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
6704 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02006705 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01006706
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006707
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01006708log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01006709 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
6710 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6711 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01006712
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01006713 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
6714 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
6715 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
6716 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
6717 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01006718
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02006719 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
6720 "option httplog" directives.
6721
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02006722log-format-sd <string>
6723 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
6724 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6725 yes | yes | yes | no
6726
6727 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
6728 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
6729 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
6730 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
6731 which covers the log format string in depth.
6732
6733 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
6734 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
6735
6736 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
6737 log format to "rfc5424".
6738
6739 Example :
6740 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
6741
6742
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01006743log-tag <string>
6744 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
6745 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6746 yes | yes | yes | yes
6747
6748 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
6749 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
6750 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
6751 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
6752 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
6753 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
6754 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
6755 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
6756 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006757
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02006758max-keep-alive-queue <value>
6759 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
6760 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6761 yes | no | yes | yes
6762
6763 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
6764 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
6765 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
6766 servers.
6767
6768 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
6769 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
6770 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
6771 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
6772 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006773 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02006774 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
6775 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
6776 picking a different server.
6777
6778 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
6779 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
6780 even if they have to be queued.
6781
6782 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
6783 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
6784
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01006785max-session-srv-conns <nb>
6786 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
6787 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
6788 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02006789
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006790maxconn <conns>
6791 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
6792 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6793 yes | yes | yes | no
6794 Arguments :
6795 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
6796 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
6797 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
6798 closes.
6799
6800 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
6801 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
6802 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
6803 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01006804 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
6805 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
6806 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
6807 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006808
6809 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
6810 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
6811 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
6812
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01006813 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
6814 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02006815
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006816 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
6817
6818
6819mode { tcp|http|health }
6820 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
6821 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6822 yes | yes | yes | yes
6823 Arguments :
6824 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
6825 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
6826 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
6827 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
6828
6829 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
6830 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
6831 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
6832 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
6833 brings HAProxy most of its value.
6834
6835 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02006836 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
6837 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
6838 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
6839 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
6840 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
6841 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
6842 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006843
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006844 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
6845 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
6846 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006847
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006848 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006849 defaults http_instances
6850 mode http
6851
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006852 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006853
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006854
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01006855monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006856 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006857 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6858 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006859 Arguments :
6860 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
6861 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006862 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006863 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
6864 backend and its backup.
6865
6866 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
6867 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
6868 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
6869 servers in a list of backends.
6870
6871 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
6872 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
6873 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
6874 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
6875 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
6876 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
6877 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02006878 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
6879 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006880
6881 Example:
6882 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006883 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006884 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
6885 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
6886 monitor-uri /site_alive
6887 monitor fail if site_dead
6888
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02006889 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006890
6891
6892monitor-net <source>
6893 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
6894 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6895 yes | yes | yes | no
6896 Arguments :
6897 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
6898 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
6899 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
6900 followed by a mask.
6901
6902 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
6903 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006904 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006905 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
6906
6907 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
6908 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
6909 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
6910 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02006911 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
6912 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
6913 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006914
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02006915 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
6916 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
6917 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
6918 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
6919 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
6920 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006921
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01006922 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
6923 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006924
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006925 Example :
6926 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
6927 frontend www
6928 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
6929
6930 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
6931
6932
6933monitor-uri <uri>
6934 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
6935 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6936 yes | yes | yes | no
6937 Arguments :
6938 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
6939 health status instead of forwarding the request.
6940
6941 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
6942 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
6943 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
6944 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
6945 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
6946 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
6947 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
6948 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
6949
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01006950 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006951 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
6952 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
6953 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
6954 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
6955 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
6956 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006957
Christopher Faulet6072beb2020-02-18 15:34:58 +01006958 Note: if <uri> starts by a slash ('/'), the matching is performed against the
6959 request's path instead of the request's uri. It is a workaround to let
6960 the HTTP/2 requests match the monitor-uri. Indeed, in HTTP/2, clients
6961 are encouraged to send absolute URIs only.
6962
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006963 Example :
6964 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
6965 frontend www
6966 mode http
6967 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
6968
6969 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
6970
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006971
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006972option abortonclose
6973no option abortonclose
6974 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
6975 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6976 yes | no | yes | yes
6977 Arguments : none
6978
6979 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
6980 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
6981 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
6982 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006983 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006984 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
6985 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
6986 encountered while delivering the response.
6987
6988 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
6989 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
6990 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
6991 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
6992 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
6993 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006994 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006995 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006996 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006997 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
6998 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
6999 still not served and not pollute the servers.
7000
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007001 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
7002 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007003 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
7004 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
7005 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
7006 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
7007 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
7008 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007009 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007010
7011 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7012 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7013
7014 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
7015
7016
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007017option accept-invalid-http-request
7018no option accept-invalid-http-request
7019 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
7020 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7021 yes | yes | yes | no
7022 Arguments : none
7023
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007024 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007025 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007026 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007027 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
7028 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
7029 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
7030 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
7031 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01007032 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
7033 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
7034 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
7035 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007036 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007037 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02007038 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
7039 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
7040 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007041
7042 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
7043 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
7044 been confirmed.
7045
7046 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
7047 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01007048 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
7049 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007050 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
7051
7052 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7053 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7054
7055 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
7056 stats socket.
7057
7058
7059option accept-invalid-http-response
7060no option accept-invalid-http-response
7061 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
7062 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7063 yes | no | yes | yes
7064 Arguments : none
7065
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007066 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007067 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007068 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007069 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
7070 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
7071 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
7072 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
7073 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007074 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
7075 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
7076 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007077
7078 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
7079 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
7080 been confirmed.
7081
7082 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
7083 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
7084 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
7085 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
7086
7087 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7088 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7089
7090 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
7091 stats socket.
7092
7093
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007094option allbackups
7095no option allbackups
7096 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
7097 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7098 yes | no | yes | yes
7099 Arguments : none
7100
7101 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
7102 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
7103 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
7104 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
7105 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
7106 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
7107 order between the backup servers anymore.
7108
7109 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
7110 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
7111
7112 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7113 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7114
7115
7116option checkcache
7117no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08007118 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007119 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7120 yes | no | yes | yes
7121 Arguments : none
7122
7123 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
7124 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007125 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007126 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
7127 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007128 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007129
7130 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007131 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007132 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007133 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
7134 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007135 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007136 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01007137 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
7138 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007139 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01007140 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
7141 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007142 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007143 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
7144 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
7145 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
7146 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
7147 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
7148 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
7149 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
7150 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
7151 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
7152
7153 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007154 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
7155 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
7156 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
7157 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007158
7159 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
7160 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007161 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007162 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007163
7164 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7165 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7166
7167
7168option clitcpka
7169no option clitcpka
7170 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
7171 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7172 yes | yes | yes | no
7173 Arguments : none
7174
7175 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7176 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007177 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007178 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7179
7180 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7181 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7182 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7183 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7184
7185 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7186 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7187 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7188 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7189 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7190
7191 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7192
7193 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
7194 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
7195 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
7196
7197 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7198 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7199
7200 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
7201
7202
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007203option contstats
7204 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
7205 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7206 yes | yes | yes | no
7207 Arguments : none
7208
7209 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
7210 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
7211 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
7212 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01007213 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
7214 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
7215 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
7216 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
7217 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007218
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02007219option disable-h2-upgrade
7220no option disable-h2-upgrade
7221 Enable or disable the implicit HTTP/2 upgrade from an HTTP/1.x client
7222 connection.
7223 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7224 yes | yes | yes | no
7225 Arguments : none
7226
7227 By default, HAProxy is able to implicitly upgrade an HTTP/1.x client
7228 connection to an HTTP/2 connection if the first request it receives from a
7229 given HTTP connection matches the HTTP/2 connection preface (i.e. the string
7230 "PRI * HTTP/2.0\r\n\r\nSM\r\n\r\n"). This way, it is possible to support
7231 HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 clients on a non-SSL connections. This option must be used to
7232 disable the implicit upgrade. Note this implicit upgrade is only supported
7233 for HTTP proxies, thus this option too. Note also it is possible to force the
7234 HTTP/2 on clear connections by specifying "proto h2" on the bind line.
7235
7236 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7237 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007238
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007239option dontlog-normal
7240no option dontlog-normal
7241 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
7242 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7243 yes | yes | yes | no
7244 Arguments : none
7245
7246 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
7247 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
7248 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
7249 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
7250 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
7251 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
7252 logged.
7253
7254 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
7255 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
7256 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
7257
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007258 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007259 logging.
7260
7261
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007262option dontlognull
7263no option dontlognull
7264 Enable or disable logging of null connections
7265 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7266 yes | yes | yes | no
7267 Arguments : none
7268
7269 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
7270 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
7271 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
7272 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
7273 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
7274 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007275 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
7276 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
7277 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007278
7279 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007280 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007281 would not be logged.
7282
7283 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7284 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7285
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007286 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
7287 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007288
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007289
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007290option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007291 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
7292 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7293 yes | yes | yes | yes
7294 Arguments :
7295 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
7296 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007297 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007298 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007299
7300 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
7301 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
7302 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
7303 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
7304 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
7305 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
7306 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007307 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
7308 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
7309 possible that the client has already brought one.
7310
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007311 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007312 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007313 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007314 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007315 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007316 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007317
7318 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
7319 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
7320 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
7321 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
7322 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
7323 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
7324 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
7325
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007326 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
7327 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
7328 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
7329 are under the control of the end-user.
7330
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007331 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007332 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
7333 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007334 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
7335 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
7336 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007337
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007338 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007339 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
7340 frontend www
7341 mode http
7342 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
7343
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007344 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
7345 backend www
7346 mode http
7347 option forwardfor header X-Client
7348
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007349 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007350 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007351
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007352
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02007353option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
7354no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
7355 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
7356 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7357 yes | yes | yes | no
7358 Arguments : none
7359
7360 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
7361 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
7362 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
7363 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
7364 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
7365 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
7366 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
7367
7368 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
7369 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
7370 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
7371 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
7372 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
7373 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
7374 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
7375 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
7376 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
7377 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
7378
7379 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
7380
7381 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7382 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7383
7384 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
7385 "h1-case-adjust-file".
7386
7387
7388option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
7389no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
7390 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
7391 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7392 yes | no | yes | yes
7393 Arguments : none
7394
7395 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
7396 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
7397 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
7398 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
7399 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
7400 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
7401 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
7402
7403 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
7404 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
7405 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
7406 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
7407 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
7408 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
7409 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
7410 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
7411 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
7412 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
7413
7414 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
7415
7416 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7417 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7418
7419 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
7420 "h1-case-adjust-file".
7421
7422
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007423option http-buffer-request
7424no option http-buffer-request
7425 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
7426 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7427 yes | yes | yes | yes
7428 Arguments : none
7429
7430 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
7431 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
7432 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
7433 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
7434 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
7435 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01007436 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
7437 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
7438 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
7439 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007440
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01007441 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007442
7443
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007444option http-ignore-probes
7445no option http-ignore-probes
7446 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
7447 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7448 yes | yes | yes | no
7449 Arguments : none
7450
7451 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
7452 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
7453 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
7454 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
7455 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
7456 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
7457 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
7458 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
7459 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007460 was received over a connection before it was closed;
7461 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007462 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
7463
7464 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
7465 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
7466 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
7467 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
7468 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
7469 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
7470 are often the only way to detect them.
7471
7472 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7473 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7474
7475 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
7476
7477
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007478option http-keep-alive
7479no option http-keep-alive
7480 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
7481 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7482 yes | yes | yes | yes
7483 Arguments : none
7484
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007485 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
7486 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007487 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
7488 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007489 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". This option allows to
7490 set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when another mode was used
7491 in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007492
7493 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
7494 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007495 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
7496 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
7497 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
7498 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
7499 situations where this option may be useful :
7500
7501 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007502 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007503
7504 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
7505 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
7506
7507 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
7508 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
7509 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
7510 request.
7511
7512 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
7513 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007514 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
7515 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
7516 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007517
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007518 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
7519 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
7520 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
7521 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
7522 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
7523 not set.
7524
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007525 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
7526 http-server-close". When backend and frontend options differ, all of these 4
7527 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007528
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007529 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007530 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01007531 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007532
7533
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02007534option http-no-delay
7535no option http-no-delay
7536 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
7537 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7538 yes | yes | yes | yes
7539 Arguments : none
7540
7541 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
7542 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
7543 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
7544 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
7545 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
7546 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
7547 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
7548 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
7549 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
7550 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
7551 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
7552 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
7553 affected.
7554
7555 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
7556 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
7557 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
7558 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
7559 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
7560 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
7561 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
7562 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
7563 latency environments.
7564
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007565 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
7566
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02007567
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007568option http-pretend-keepalive
7569no option http-pretend-keepalive
7570 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
7571 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02007572 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007573 Arguments : none
7574
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007575 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", haproxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007576 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
7577 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
7578 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
7579 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
7580 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
7581 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
7582 consider the response complete.
7583
7584 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
7585 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
7586 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
7587 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007588 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007589 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
7590
7591 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
7592 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
7593 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
7594 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
7595 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
7596 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
7597 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
7598
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02007599 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
7600 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
7601 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
7602 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
7603 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
7604 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007605
7606 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7607 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7608
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007609 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007610 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007611
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007612
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007613option http-server-close
7614no option http-server-close
7615 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
7616 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7617 yes | yes | yes | yes
7618 Arguments : none
7619
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007620 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
7621 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
7622 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
7623 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007624 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". Setting "option
7625 http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server side
7626 while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the
7627 client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
7628 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
7629 resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits non-keepalive
7630 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
7631 conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers do not
7632 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
7633 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
7634 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007635
7636 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
7637 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
7638 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
7639 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007640 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
7641 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007642
7643 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
7644 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007645 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
7646 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
7647 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007648
7649 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7650 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7651
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007652 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
7653 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007654
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007655option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01007656no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007657 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
7658 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7659 yes | yes | yes | no
7660 Arguments : none
7661
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00007662 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007663 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
7664 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
7665 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
7666 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
7667 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
7668 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
7669
7670 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
7671 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01007672 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
7673 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
7674 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007675
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01007676 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
7677 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
7678 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
7679 front of an existing proxy.
7680
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007681 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
7682
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007683 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007684
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007685option httpchk
7686option httpchk <uri>
7687option httpchk <method> <uri>
7688option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02007689 Enables HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007690 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7691 yes | no | yes | yes
7692 Arguments :
7693 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
7694 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
7695 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
7696 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
7697 ones.
7698
7699 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
7700 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
7701 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
7702
7703 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
7704 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
7705 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02007706 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "http-check send" directive to add it.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007707
7708 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
7709 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
7710 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
7711 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
7712 the lack of any response.
7713
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02007714 Combined with "http-check" directives, it is possible to customize the
7715 request sent during the HTTP health checks or the matching rules on the
7716 response. It is also possible to configure a send/expect sequence, just like
7717 with the directive "tcp-check" for TCP health checks.
7718
7719 The server configuration is used by default to open connections to perform
7720 HTTP health checks. By it is also possible to overwrite server parameters
7721 using "http-check connect" rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007722
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02007723 "httpchk" option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works
7724 with plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02007725 bound to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon. However, it will always
7726 internally relies on an HTX mutliplexer. Thus, it means the request
7727 formatting and the response parsing will be strict.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007728
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02007729 Note : For a while, there was no way to add headers or body in the request
7730 used for HTTP health checks. So a workaround was to hide it at the end
7731 of the version string with a "\r\n" after the version. It is now
7732 deprecated. The directive "http-check send" must be used instead.
7733
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007734 Examples :
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02007735 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
7736 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
7737 backend https_relay
7738 mode tcp
7739 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1
7740 http-check send hdr Host www
7741 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007742
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09007743 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
7744 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
7745 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007746
7747
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007748option httpclose
7749no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007750 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007751 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7752 yes | yes | yes | yes
7753 Arguments : none
7754
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007755 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
7756 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
7757 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
7758 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007759 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007760
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007761 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
7762 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05007763 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007764 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
7765 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007766
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007767 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
7768 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
7769 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007770
7771 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
7772 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007773 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
7774 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
7775 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007776
7777 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7778 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7779
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007780 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007781
7782
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007783option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007784 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
7785 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01007786 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007787 Arguments :
7788 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
7789 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
7790 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007791 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007792 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007793
7794 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
7795 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
7796 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
7797 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
7798 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
7799 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
7800 ports.
7801
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01007802 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
7803 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007804
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007805 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
7806
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007807 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007808
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007809
7810option http_proxy
7811no option http_proxy
7812 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
7813 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7814 yes | yes | yes | yes
7815 Arguments : none
7816
7817 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
7818 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
7819 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
7820 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
7821 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
7822
7823 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
7824 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01007825 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
7826 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007827
7828 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7829 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7830
7831 Example :
7832 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
7833 backend direct_forward
7834 option httpclose
7835 option http_proxy
7836
7837 See also : "option httpclose"
7838
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007839
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007840option independent-streams
7841no option independent-streams
7842 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02007843 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7844 yes | yes | yes | yes
7845 Arguments : none
7846
7847 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
7848 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
7849 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
7850 receive data or not.
7851
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007852 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02007853 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
7854 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
7855 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
7856 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
7857 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
7858 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
7859 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
7860 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
7861 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
7862 socket buffers.
7863
7864 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
7865 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
7866 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
7867 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
7868 slow lines, so use it with caution.
7869
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007870 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02007871
7872
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02007873option ldap-check
7874 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
7875 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7876 yes | no | yes | yes
7877 Arguments : none
7878
7879 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
7880 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
7881 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
7882 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
7883
7884 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
7885 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
7886
7887 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
7888 configure it.
7889
7890 Example :
7891 option ldap-check
7892
7893 See also : "option httpchk"
7894
7895
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007896option external-check
7897 Use external processes for server health checks
7898 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7899 yes | no | yes | yes
7900
7901 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
7902 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
7903 command".
7904
7905 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
7906
7907 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
7908
7909
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007910option log-health-checks
7911no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007912 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007913 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7914 yes | no | yes | yes
7915 Arguments : none
7916
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007917 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
7918 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
7919 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007920
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007921 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
7922 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
7923 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
7924 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
7925 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
7926
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007927 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007928 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007929
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007930 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
7931 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
7932 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007933
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007934
7935option log-separate-errors
7936no option log-separate-errors
7937 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
7938 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7939 yes | yes | yes | no
7940 Arguments : none
7941
7942 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
7943 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
7944 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
7945 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
7946 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
7947 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
7948 provides very important information.
7949
7950 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
7951 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
7952 error logs.
7953
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007954 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007955 logging.
7956
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007957
7958option logasap
7959no option logasap
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02007960 Enable or disable early logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007961 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7962 yes | yes | yes | no
7963 Arguments : none
7964
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02007965 By default, logs are emitted when all the log format variables and sample
7966 fetches used in the definition of the log-format string return a value, or
7967 when the session is terminated. This allows the built in log-format strings
7968 to account for the transfer time, or the number of bytes in log messages.
7969
7970 When handling long lived connections such as large file transfers or RDP,
7971 it may take a while for the request or connection to appear in the logs.
7972 Using "option logasap", the log message is created as soon as the server
7973 connection is established in mode tcp, or as soon as the server sends the
7974 complete headers in mode http. Missing information in the logs will be the
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05007975 total number of bytes which will only indicate the amount of data transferred
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02007976 before the message was created and the total time which will not take the
7977 remainder of the connection life or transfer time into account. For the case
7978 of HTTP, it is good practice to capture the Content-Length response header
7979 so that the logs at least indicate how many bytes are expected to be
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05007980 transferred.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007981
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007982 Examples :
7983 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
7984 mode http
7985 option httplog
7986 option logasap
7987 log 192.168.2.200 local3
7988
7989 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
7990 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
7991 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
7992 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
7993
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007994 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007995 logging.
7996
7997
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02007998option mysql-check [ user <username> [ { post-41 | pre-41 } ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007999 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008000 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8001 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008002 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008003 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
8004 server.
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02008005 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks (the default)
8006 pre-41 Send pre v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008007
8008 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
8009 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008010 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008011 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
8012 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
8013 in the MySQL table, like this :
8014
8015 USE mysql;
8016 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
8017 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
8018
8019 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008020 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008021 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
8022 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
8023 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
8024 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
8025 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
8026 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
8027 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
8028
8029 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
8030 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008031
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02008032 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008033
8034 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
8035 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
8036 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
8037 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02008038 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
8039 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008040
8041 See also: "option httpchk"
8042
8043
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008044option nolinger
8045no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008046 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008047 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8048 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008049 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008050
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008051 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008052 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
8053 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
8054 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
8055 connections.
8056
8057 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
8058 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
8059 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
8060 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
8061 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
8062 this too.
8063
8064 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
8065 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
8066 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
8067
8068 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
8069 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
8070 for servers.
8071
8072 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8073 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8074
8075
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008076option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
8077 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
8078 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8079 yes | yes | yes | yes
8080 Arguments :
8081 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
8082 matching <network>
8083 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
8084 header name.
8085
8086 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
8087 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
8088 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
8089 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
8090 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
8091 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
8092 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
8093 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
8094 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
8095 possible that the client has already brought one.
8096
8097 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
8098 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
8099 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
8100 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
8101 header and requires different one.
8102
8103 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
8104 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
8105 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
8106 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
8107 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
8108 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
8109 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
8110
8111 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
8112 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
8113 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
8114 both are defined.
8115
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008116 Examples :
8117 # Original Destination address
8118 frontend www
8119 mode http
8120 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
8121
8122 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
8123 backend www
8124 mode http
8125 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
8126
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008127 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008128
8129
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008130option persist
8131no option persist
8132 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
8133 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8134 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008135 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008136
8137 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
8138 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
8139 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
8140 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
8141 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
8142 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
8143 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
8144 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
8145 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
8146 redirected to another valid server.
8147
8148 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8149 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8150
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01008151 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008152
8153
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01008154option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
8155 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
8156 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8157 yes | no | yes | yes
8158 Arguments :
8159 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
8160 PostgreSQL server.
8161
8162 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
8163 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
8164 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
8165 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
8166
8167 See also: "option httpchk"
8168
8169
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008170option prefer-last-server
8171no option prefer-last-server
8172 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
8173 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8174 yes | no | yes | yes
8175 Arguments : none
8176
8177 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
8178 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
8179 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
8180 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
8181 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
8182 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
8183 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
8184 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
8185 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01008186 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
8187 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02008188 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
8189 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
8190 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01008191 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
8192 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
8193 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008194
8195 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8196 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8197
8198 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
8199
8200
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008201option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008202option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008203no option redispatch
8204 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
8205 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8206 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008207 Arguments :
8208 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
8209 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
8210 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008211 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008212 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008213 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008214 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
8215 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
8216 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
8217
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008218
8219 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
8220 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
8221 be able to access the service anymore.
8222
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01008223 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
8224 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008225
Olivier Carrère6e6f59b2020-04-15 11:30:18 +02008226 Active servers are selected from a subset of the list of available
8227 servers. Active servers that are not down or in maintenance (i.e., whose
8228 health is not checked or that have been checked as "up"), are selected in the
8229 following order:
8230
8231 1. Any active, non-backup server, if any, or,
8232
8233 2. If the "allbackups" option is not set, the first backup server in the
8234 list, or
8235
8236 3. If the "allbackups" option is set, any backup server.
8237
8238 When a retry occurs, HAProxy tries to select another server than the last
8239 one. The new server is selected from the current list of servers.
8240
8241 Sometimes, if the list is updated between retries (e.g., if numerous retries
8242 occur and last longer than the time needed to check that a server is down,
8243 remove it from the list and fall back on the list of backup servers),
8244 connections may be redirected to a backup server, though.
8245
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008246 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008247 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
8248 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008249
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008250 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8251 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8252
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008253 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008254
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008255
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02008256option redis-check
8257 Use redis health checks for server testing
8258 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8259 yes | no | yes | yes
8260 Arguments : none
8261
8262 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
8263 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
8264 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
8265 find the "+PONG" response message.
8266
8267 Example :
8268 option redis-check
8269
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03008270 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02008271
8272
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008273option smtpchk
8274option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
8275 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
8276 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8277 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008278 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008279 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02008280 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008281 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
8282
8283 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
8284 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
8285 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
8286
8287 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
8288 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
8289 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
8290 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
8291 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
8292 dead server.
8293
8294 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
8295 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008296 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008297 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
8298
8299 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
8300 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
8301 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
8302 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02008303 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008304
8305 Example :
8306 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
8307
8308 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
8309
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008310
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02008311option socket-stats
8312no option socket-stats
8313
8314 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
8315 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8316 yes | yes | yes | no
8317
8318 Arguments : none
8319
8320
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008321option splice-auto
8322no option splice-auto
8323 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
8324 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8325 yes | yes | yes | yes
8326 Arguments : none
8327
8328 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
8329 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008330 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008331 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008332 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008333 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
8334 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
8335 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
8336 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
8337
8338 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
8339 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
8340 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
8341 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
8342 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
8343 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
8344 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
8345 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
8346 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
8347 keyword.
8348
8349 Example :
8350 option splice-auto
8351
8352 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8353 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8354
8355 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
8356 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
8357
8358
8359option splice-request
8360no option splice-request
8361 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
8362 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8363 yes | yes | yes | yes
8364 Arguments : none
8365
8366 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008367 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008368 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
8369 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
8370 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
8371 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
8372
8373 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
8374
8375 Example :
8376 option splice-request
8377
8378 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8379 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8380
8381 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
8382 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
8383
8384
8385option splice-response
8386no option splice-response
8387 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
8388 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8389 yes | yes | yes | yes
8390 Arguments : none
8391
8392 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008393 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008394 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
8395 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
8396 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
8397 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
8398
8399 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
8400
8401 Example :
8402 option splice-response
8403
8404 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8405 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8406
8407 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
8408 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
8409
8410
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01008411option spop-check
8412 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
8413 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8414 no | no | no | yes
8415 Arguments : none
8416
8417 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
8418 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
8419 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
8420 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
8421
8422 Example :
8423 option spop-check
8424
8425 See also : "option httpchk"
8426
8427
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008428option srvtcpka
8429no option srvtcpka
8430 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
8431 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8432 yes | no | yes | yes
8433 Arguments : none
8434
8435 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
8436 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008437 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008438 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
8439
8440 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
8441 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
8442 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
8443 operating system and its tuning parameters.
8444
8445 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
8446 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
8447 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
8448 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
8449 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
8450
8451 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
8452
8453 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
8454 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
8455 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
8456
8457 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8458 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8459
8460 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
8461
8462
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008463option ssl-hello-chk
8464 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
8465 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8466 yes | no | yes | yes
8467 Arguments : none
8468
8469 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
8470 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
8471 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
8472 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
8473 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
8474 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
8475 hello message.
8476
8477 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
8478 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
8479 messages, which is appreciable.
8480
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008481 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
8482 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
8483 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008484
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008485 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
8486
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008487
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008488option tcp-check
8489 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
8490 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8491 yes | no | yes | yes
8492
8493 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
8494 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
8495
8496 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
8497 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
8498 attempt, which remains the default mode.
8499
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008500 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008501 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
8502 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
8503 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
8504 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
8505 only.
8506
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008507 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008508 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
8509 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
8510 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
8511 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
8512
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008513 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008514 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
8515 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008516 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008517 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
8518 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
8519 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
8520 the respective protocols.
8521 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008522 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008523
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008524 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the script.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008525
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008526 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
8527 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr in
8528 debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting. The
8529 "comment" is of course optional.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008530
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008531 During the execution of a health check, a variable scope is made available to
8532 store data samples, using the "tcp-check set-var" operation. Freeing those
8533 variable is possible using "tcp-check unset-var".
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +01008534
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008535
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008536 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008537 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008538 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008539 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008540
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008541 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008542 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008543 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008544
8545 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
8546 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008547 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008548 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008549 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008550 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02008551 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008552 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008553 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
8554 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008555 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008556 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
8557 tcp-check expect string +OK
8558
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008559 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008560 (send many headers before analyzing)
8561 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008562 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008563 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
8564 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
8565 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
8566 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008567 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008568
8569
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008570 See also : "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect" and "tcp-check send".
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008571
8572
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02008573option tcp-smart-accept
8574no option tcp-smart-accept
8575 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
8576 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8577 yes | yes | yes | no
8578 Arguments : none
8579
8580 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
8581 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
8582 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
8583 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
8584 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
8585 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
8586
8587 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
8588 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
8589 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
8590 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
8591
8592 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
8593 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
8594 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008595 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02008596
8597 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
8598 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
8599 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
8600
8601 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
8602 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
8603 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
8604
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02008605 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
8606
8607
8608option tcp-smart-connect
8609no option tcp-smart-connect
8610 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
8611 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8612 yes | no | yes | yes
8613 Arguments : none
8614
8615 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
8616 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
8617 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
8618 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
8619 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
8620
8621 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
8622 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
8623 complex.
8624
8625 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
8626 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
8627 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
8628
8629 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8630 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8631
8632 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
8633
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02008634
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008635option tcpka
8636 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
8637 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8638 yes | yes | yes | yes
8639 Arguments : none
8640
8641 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
8642 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008643 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008644 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
8645
8646 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
8647 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
8648 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
8649 operating system and its tuning parameters.
8650
8651 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
8652 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
8653 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
8654 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
8655 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
8656
8657 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
8658
8659 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
8660 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
8661 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
8662 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
8663 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
8664 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
8665 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
8666 backends.
8667
8668 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
8669
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008670
8671option tcplog
8672 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
8673 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01008674 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008675 Arguments : none
8676
8677 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
8678 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
8679 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
8680 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
8681 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
8682 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
8683 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
8684 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
8685
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02008686 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
8687
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008688 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008689
8690
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008691option transparent
8692no option transparent
8693 Enable client-side transparent proxying
8694 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01008695 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008696 Arguments : none
8697
8698 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
8699 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
8700 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
8701 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
8702 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
8703 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
8704 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
8705 appropriate server.
8706
8707 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
8708 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
8709
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01008710 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008711 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008712
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008713
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008714external-check command <command>
8715 Executable to run when performing an external-check
8716 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8717 yes | no | yes | yes
8718
8719 Arguments :
8720 <command> is the external command to run
8721
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008722 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
8723
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01008724 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008725
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01008726 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
8727 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
8728 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
8729 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
8730 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
8731 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008732
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01008733 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
8734
8735 Environment variables :
8736 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
8737 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
8738
8739 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
8740
8741 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
8742
8743 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
8744 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
8745 for a UNIX socket).
8746
8747 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
8748
8749 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
8750
8751 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
8752
8753 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
8754
8755 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
8756
8757 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
8758 socket).
8759
8760 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
8761 the command may be set using "external-check path".
8762
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02008763 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
8764
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008765 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
8766 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
8767 failed.
8768
8769 Example :
8770 external-check command /bin/true
8771
8772 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
8773
8774
8775external-check path <path>
8776 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
8777 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8778 yes | no | yes | yes
8779
8780 Arguments :
8781 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
8782
8783 The default path is "".
8784
8785 Example :
8786 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
8787
8788 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
8789 "external-check command"
8790
8791
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008792persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008793persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008794 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
8795 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8796 yes | no | yes | yes
8797 Arguments :
8798 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02008799 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
8800 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008801
8802 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
8803 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008804 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008805 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
8806 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
8807 forwarded to this server.
8808
8809 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
8810 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
8811 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008812 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008813 a single "listen" section.
8814
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02008815 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
8816 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
8817 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
8818
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008819 Example :
8820 listen tse-farm
8821 bind :3389
8822 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
8823 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
8824 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
8825 # apply RDP cookie persistence
8826 persist rdp-cookie
8827 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008828 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008829 balance rdp-cookie
8830 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
8831 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
8832
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09008833 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
8834 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008835
8836
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01008837rate-limit sessions <rate>
8838 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
8839 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8840 yes | yes | yes | no
8841 Arguments :
8842 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
8843 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
8844
8845 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
8846 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
8847 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
8848 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
8849 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
8850 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
8851
8852 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
8853 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
8854 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
8855 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
8856
8857 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
8858 listen smtp
8859 mode tcp
8860 bind :25
8861 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02008862 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01008863
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02008864 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
8865 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
8866 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01008867
8868 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
8869
8870
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008871redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8872redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8873redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008874 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
8875 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8876 no | yes | yes | yes
8877
8878 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01008879 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008880
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008881 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008882 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008883 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
8884 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
8885 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008886
8887 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
8888 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
8889 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
8890 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
8891 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008892 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
8893 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
8894 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
8895 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008896
8897 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
8898 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
8899 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
8900 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
8901 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
8902 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008903 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008904 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008905 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
8906 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
8907 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008908
8909 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01008910 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
8911 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
8912 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02008913 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01008914 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
8915 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
8916 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
8917 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008918
8919 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008920 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008921
8922 - "drop-query"
8923 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
8924 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
8925 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
8926 with a location-type redirect.
8927
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01008928 - "append-slash"
8929 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
8930 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
8931 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
8932 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
8933
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008934 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
8935 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
8936 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
8937 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
8938 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
8939 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
8940 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
8941
8942 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
8943 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
8944 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
8945 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
8946 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
8947 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
8948 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008949
8950 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
8951 acl clear dst_port 80
8952 acl secure dst_port 8080
8953 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008954 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01008955 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008956 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
8957
8958 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01008959 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
8960 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
8961 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008962 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008963
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01008964 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
8965 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
8966 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
8967
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008968 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01008969 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008970
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008971 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02008972 http-request redirect code 301 location \
8973 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
8974 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008975
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008976 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008977
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008978
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02008979retries <value>
8980 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
8981 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8982 yes | no | yes | yes
8983 Arguments :
8984 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
8985 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
8986 default value is 3.
8987
8988 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
8989 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
8990 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
8991
8992 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008993 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
8994 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02008995
8996 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
8997 server even if a cookie references a different server.
8998
8999 See also : "option redispatch"
9000
9001
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009002retry-on [list of keywords]
Jerome Magnin5ce3c142020-05-13 20:09:57 +02009003 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request.
9004 This setting is only valid when "mode" is set to http and is silently ignored
9005 otherwise.
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009006 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9007 yes | no | yes | yes
9008 Arguments :
9009 <keywords> is a list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each representing a
9010 type of failure event on which an attempt to retry the request
9011 is desired. Please read the notes at the bottom before changing
9012 this setting. The following keywords are supported :
9013
9014 none never retry
9015
9016 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
9017 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
9018
9019 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
9020 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
9021 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
9022 request timeout on the server side, poor network
9023 condition, or a server crash or restart while
9024 processing the request.
9025
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +02009026 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
9027 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
9028 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
9029 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
9030 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
9031 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
9032 overflow attack for example).
9033
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009034 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
9035 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
9036 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
9037 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
9038 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
9039 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
9040 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
9041 amplify denial of service attacks.
9042
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +02009043 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
9044 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
9045 considered to be safe to retry.
9046
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009047 <status> any HTTP status code among "404" (Not Found), "408"
9048 (Request Timeout), "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server
9049 Error), "501" (Not Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway),
9050 "503" (Service Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
9051
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +02009052 all-retryable-errors
9053 retry request for any error that are considered
9054 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
9055 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
9056 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
9057
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009058 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
9059 not cumulative.
9060
9061 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
9062 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
9063 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
9064 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
9065
9066 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
9067 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
9068 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
9069 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
9070 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
9071 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
9072 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
9073 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
9074 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
9075 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
9076 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
9077 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
9078
9079 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
9080 should not use this directive.
9081
9082 The default is "conn-failure".
9083
9084 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
9085
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01009086server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009087 Declare a server in a backend
9088 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9089 no | no | yes | yes
9090 Arguments :
9091 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009092 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05009093 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009094
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01009095 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
9096 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
9097 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
9098 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02009099 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
9100 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
9101 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
9102 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
9103 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009104 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
9105 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
9106 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
9107 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
9108 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
9109 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
9110 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02009111 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02009112 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
9113 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
9114 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
9115 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
9116 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
9117 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02009118 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
9119 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01009120 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
9121 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009122
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009123 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009124 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
9125 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
9126 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
9127 adding this value to the client's port.
9128
9129 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
9130 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009131 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009132
9133 Examples :
9134 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
9135 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009136 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02009137 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
9138 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
9139 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009140
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02009141 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
9142 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
9143 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
9144 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
9145 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
9146
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05009147 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
9148 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009149
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02009150server-state-file-name [<file>]
9151 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
9152 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
9153 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
9154 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
9155 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
9156 global directive "server-state-file-base".
9157
9158 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
9159 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
9160
9161 global
9162 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
9163
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +01009164 backend bk
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02009165 load-server-state-from-file
9166
9167 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
9168 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009169
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02009170server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
9171 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
9172 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
9173 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9174 no | no | yes | yes
9175
9176 Arguments:
9177 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
9178
9179 <num | range>
9180 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
9181 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
9182 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
9183 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
9184
9185 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
9186
9187 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
9188
9189 <params*>
9190 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
9191 keyword.
9192
9193 Examples:
9194 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
9195 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
9196 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
9197
9198 # or
9199 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
9200
9201 # would be equivalent to:
9202 server srv1 google.com:80 check
9203 server srv2 google.com:80 check
9204 server srv3 google.com:80 check
9205
9206
9207
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009208source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009209source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01009210source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009211 Set the source address for outgoing connections
9212 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9213 yes | no | yes | yes
9214 Arguments :
9215 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
9216 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009217
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009218 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009219 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
9220 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
9221 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
9222 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
9223 supported prefixes are :
9224 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
9225 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
9226 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02009227 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02009228 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
9229 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009230
9231 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
9232 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009233 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
9234 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
9235 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009236
9237 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
9238 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
9239 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
9240 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
9241 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
9242 <addr>.
9243
9244 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
9245 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
9246 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
9247 port.
9248
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009249 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
9250 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
9251 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
9252 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01009253 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009254 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
9255 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
9256 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
9257 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
9258 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
9259 HTTP header.
9260
9261 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
9262 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009263 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009264 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
9265 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
9266 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
9267 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
9268 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
9269 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
9270 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
9271
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01009272 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
9273 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
9274 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
9275 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
9276 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
9277 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
9278
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009279 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
9280 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
9281 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
9282 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
9283
9284 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
9285 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
9286 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
9287 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
9288 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
9289 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
9290
9291 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
9292 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
9293 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
9294 there are two methods :
9295
9296 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
9297 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
9298 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
9299 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
9300 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
9301 of the client ranges may be used.
9302
9303 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
9304 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
9305 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
9306 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
9307 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
9308 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
9309 same session.
9310
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009311 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
9312 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
9313 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009314 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009315
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02009316 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
9317
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009318 Examples :
9319 backend private
9320 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
9321 source 192.168.1.200
9322
9323 backend transparent_ssl1
9324 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
9325 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
9326
9327 backend transparent_ssl2
9328 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
9329 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
9330 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
9331
9332 backend transparent_ssl3
9333 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
9334 # is more conntrack-friendly.
9335 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
9336
9337 backend transparent_smtp
9338 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
9339 # with Tproxy version 4.
9340 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
9341
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009342 backend transparent_http
9343 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
9344 # proxy.
9345 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
9346
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009347 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009348 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
9349
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009350
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009351stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
9352 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
9353 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009354 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009355
9356 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
9357 matched.
9358
9359 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
9360 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
9361
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009362 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9363 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009364 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009365
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01009366 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
9367 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
9368 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
9369 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009370
9371 Example :
9372 # statistics admin level only for localhost
9373 backend stats_localhost
9374 stats enable
9375 stats admin if LOCALHOST
9376
9377 Example :
9378 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
9379 backend stats_auth
9380 stats enable
9381 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
9382 stats admin if TRUE
9383
9384 Example :
9385 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
9386 userlist stats-auth
9387 group admin users admin
9388 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
9389 group readonly users haproxy
9390 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
9391
9392 backend stats_auth
9393 stats enable
9394 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
9395 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
9396 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
9397 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
9398
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009399 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
9400 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
9401 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009402
9403
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009404stats auth <user>:<passwd>
9405 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
9406 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009407 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009408 Arguments :
9409 <user> is a user name to grant access to
9410
9411 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
9412
9413 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
9414 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
9415 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
9416 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
9417 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
9418 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
9419
9420 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
9421 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
9422 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02009423 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009424
9425 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
9426 report using "stats scope".
9427
9428 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9429 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9430 unobvious parameters.
9431
9432 Example :
9433 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9434 backend public_www
9435 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9436 stats enable
9437 stats hide-version
9438 stats scope .
9439 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009440 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009441 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9442 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9443
9444 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9445 backend private_monitoring
9446 stats enable
9447 stats uri /admin?stats
9448 stats refresh 5s
9449
9450 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
9451
9452
9453stats enable
9454 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
9455 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009456 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009457 Arguments : none
9458
9459 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
9460 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
9461 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
9462 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
9463 - stats auth : no authentication
9464 - stats scope : no restriction
9465
9466 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9467 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9468 unobvious parameters.
9469
9470 Example :
9471 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9472 backend public_www
9473 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9474 stats enable
9475 stats hide-version
9476 stats scope .
9477 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009478 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009479 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9480 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9481
9482 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9483 backend private_monitoring
9484 stats enable
9485 stats uri /admin?stats
9486 stats refresh 5s
9487
9488 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
9489
9490
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009491stats hide-version
9492 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009493 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009494 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009495 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009496
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009497 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
9498 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
9499 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
9500 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
9501 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
9502 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009503
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02009504 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9505 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9506 unobvious parameters.
9507
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009508 Example :
9509 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9510 backend public_www
9511 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02009512 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009513 stats hide-version
9514 stats scope .
9515 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009516 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009517 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9518 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009519
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009520 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9521 backend private_monitoring
9522 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009523 stats uri /admin?stats
9524 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01009525
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009526 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009527
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01009528
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02009529stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
9530 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
9531 Access control for statistics
9532
9533 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9534 no | no | yes | yes
9535
9536 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
9537 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
9538 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
9539 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
9540 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
9541 should be asked to enter a username and password.
9542
9543 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
9544 instance.
9545
9546 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
9547 about ACL usage.
9548
9549
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009550stats realm <realm>
9551 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
9552 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009553 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009554 Arguments :
9555 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
9556 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
9557 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
9558
9559 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
9560 using a backslash ('\').
9561
9562 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
9563 only related to authentication.
9564
9565 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9566 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9567 unobvious parameters.
9568
9569 Example :
9570 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9571 backend public_www
9572 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9573 stats enable
9574 stats hide-version
9575 stats scope .
9576 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009577 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009578 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9579 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9580
9581 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9582 backend private_monitoring
9583 stats enable
9584 stats uri /admin?stats
9585 stats refresh 5s
9586
9587 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
9588
9589
9590stats refresh <delay>
9591 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
9592 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009593 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009594 Arguments :
9595 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
9596 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
9597 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
9598 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
9599 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
9600 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
9601
9602 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
9603 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
9604 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
9605 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
9606
9607 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9608 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9609 unobvious parameters.
9610
9611 Example :
9612 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9613 backend public_www
9614 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9615 stats enable
9616 stats hide-version
9617 stats scope .
9618 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009619 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009620 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9621 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9622
9623 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9624 backend private_monitoring
9625 stats enable
9626 stats uri /admin?stats
9627 stats refresh 5s
9628
9629 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
9630
9631
9632stats scope { <name> | "." }
9633 Enable statistics and limit access scope
9634 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009635 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009636 Arguments :
9637 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
9638 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
9639 section in which the statement appears.
9640
9641 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
9642 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
9643 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
9644 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
9645 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
9646 exists.
9647
9648 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9649 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9650 unobvious parameters.
9651
9652 Example :
9653 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9654 backend public_www
9655 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9656 stats enable
9657 stats hide-version
9658 stats scope .
9659 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009660 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009661 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9662 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9663
9664 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9665 backend private_monitoring
9666 stats enable
9667 stats uri /admin?stats
9668 stats refresh 5s
9669
9670 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
9671
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009672
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009673stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009674 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
9675 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009676 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009677
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009678 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009679 description from global section is automatically used instead.
9680
9681 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
9682 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
9683
9684 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9685 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009686 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009687
9688 Example :
9689 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9690 backend private_monitoring
9691 stats enable
9692 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
9693 stats uri /admin?stats
9694 stats refresh 5s
9695
9696 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
9697 global section.
9698
9699
9700stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009701 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
9702 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9703 yes | yes | yes | yes
9704 Arguments : none
9705
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009706 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009707 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
9708 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
9709 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
9710 - IP (socket, server)
9711 - cookie (backend, server)
9712
9713 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9714 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009715 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009716
9717 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
9718
9719
9720stats show-node [ <name> ]
9721 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
9722 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009723 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009724 Arguments:
9725 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
9726 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
9727
9728 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
9729 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009730 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009731
9732 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9733 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9734 unobvious parameters.
9735
9736 Example:
9737 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9738 backend private_monitoring
9739 stats enable
9740 stats show-node Europe-1
9741 stats uri /admin?stats
9742 stats refresh 5s
9743
9744 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
9745 section.
9746
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009747
9748stats uri <prefix>
9749 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
9750 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009751 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009752 Arguments :
9753 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
9754 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
9755 query string.
9756
9757 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
9758 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
9759 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
9760 possible to reach it in the application.
9761
9762 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009763 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009764 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
9765 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
9766 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
9767 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
9768
9769 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
9770 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
9771 an address or a port to statistics only.
9772
9773 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9774 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9775 unobvious parameters.
9776
9777 Example :
9778 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9779 backend public_www
9780 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9781 stats enable
9782 stats hide-version
9783 stats scope .
9784 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009785 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009786 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9787 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9788
9789 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9790 backend private_monitoring
9791 stats enable
9792 stats uri /admin?stats
9793 stats refresh 5s
9794
9795 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
9796
9797
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009798stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
9799 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009800 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009801 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009802
9803 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009804 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009805 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009806 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009807 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
9808
9809 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9810 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9811 the "stick-table" statement.
9812
9813 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
9814 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
9815 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
9816 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
9817 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
9818
9819 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9820 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
9821 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
9822 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
9823 transformation rules.
9824
9825 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9826 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9827 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9828 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9829 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9830 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9831 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9832
9833 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
9834 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
9835 ACL based conditions.
9836
9837 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
9838 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
9839 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
9840 matches can be used as fallbacks.
9841
9842 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
9843 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
9844 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
9845 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
9846
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009847 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9848 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009849 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009850
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009851 Example :
9852 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
9853 # last 30 minutes
9854 backend pop
9855 mode tcp
9856 balance roundrobin
9857 stick store-request src
9858 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9859 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
9860 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
9861
9862 backend smtp
9863 mode tcp
9864 balance roundrobin
9865 stick match src table pop
9866 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
9867 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
9868
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009869 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009870 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009871
9872
9873stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
9874 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
9875 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9876 no | no | yes | yes
9877
9878 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
9879 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
9880 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
9881 for writing more maintainable configurations.
9882
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009883 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9884 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009885 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009886
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009887 Examples :
9888 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01009889 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009890
9891 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
9892 stick match src table pop if !localhost
9893 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
9894
9895
9896 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
9897 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
9898 backend http
9899 mode http
9900 balance roundrobin
9901 stick on src table https
9902 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
9903 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
9904 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
9905
9906 backend https
9907 mode tcp
9908 balance roundrobin
9909 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9910 stick on src
9911 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
9912 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
9913
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009914 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009915
9916
9917stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
9918 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
9919 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9920 no | no | yes | yes
9921
9922 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009923 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009924 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009925 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009926 server is selected.
9927
9928 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9929 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9930 the "stick-table" statement.
9931
9932 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
9933 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
9934 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
9935 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
9936 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
9937 address.
9938
9939 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9940 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
9941 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
9942 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
9943 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
9944 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
9945 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
9946 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
9947 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
9948 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
9949
9950 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9951 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9952 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9953 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9954 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9955 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9956 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9957
9958 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
9959 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
9960 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
9961 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
9962
9963 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
9964 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
9965 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
9966 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
9967 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
9968 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01009969 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
9970 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
9971 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
9972 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
9973 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
9974 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009975
9976 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
9977 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
9978 the request.
9979
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009980 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9981 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009982 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009983
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009984 Example :
9985 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
9986 # last 30 minutes
9987 backend pop
9988 mode tcp
9989 balance roundrobin
9990 stick store-request src
9991 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9992 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
9993 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
9994
9995 backend smtp
9996 mode tcp
9997 balance roundrobin
9998 stick match src table pop
9999 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
10000 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
10001
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010002 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010003 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010004
10005
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010006stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020010007 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
10008 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +080010009 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010010 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020010011 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010012
10013 Arguments :
10014 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
10015 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
10016 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
10017 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
10018
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +010010019 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
10020 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
10021 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
10022 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
10023
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010024 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
10025 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
10026 instance.
10027
10028 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
10029 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
10030 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
10031 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
10032 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
10033 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010034 to 32 characters.
10035
10036 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
10037 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
10038 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010039 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010040 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
10041 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010042
10043 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010044 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
10045 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010046 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
10047 increase.
10048
10049 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010050 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
10051 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
10052 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010053
10054 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
10055 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
10056 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
10057 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010058 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010059 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
10060 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
10061 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
10062 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
10063 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
10064 parameter (see below).
10065
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020010066 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
10067 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
10068 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
10069 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
10070 soft restart.
10071
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +020010072 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
10073 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010074
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010075 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
10076 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
10077 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
10078 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +030010079 section 2.4 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010080 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010081 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
10082 if not expiration delay is specified.
10083
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020010084 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
10085 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
10086 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
10087 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010088 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
10089 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
10090 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
10091 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
10092 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
10093 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
10094 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
10095 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
10096 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
10097 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
10098 types and their arguments.
10099
10100 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
10101 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
10102 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
10103 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
10104
10105 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
10106 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
10107 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010108 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010109
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010110 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
10111 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
10112 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010113 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010114 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010115 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010116
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010117 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
10118 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
10119 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
10120 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
10121
10122 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
10123 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
10124 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
10125 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
10126 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
10127 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
10128
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010129 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
10130 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
10131 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
10132 they were received.
10133
10134 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
10135 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
10136 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
10137 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
10138 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
10139
10140 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10141 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10142 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10143 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
10144 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
10145
10146 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
10147 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
10148 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
10149
10150 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10151 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10152 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10153 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
10154 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
10155
10156 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
10157 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
10158 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
10159 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
10160 the client side.
10161
10162 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10163 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10164 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10165 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
10166 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
10167 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
10168 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
10169
10170 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
10171 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
10172 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
10173 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
10174 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
10175 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010176 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010177
10178 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10179 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10180 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10181 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
10182 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
10183 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
10184
10185 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010186 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010187 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
10188 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
10189
10190 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10191 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10192 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10193 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
10194 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
10195 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
10196 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
10197 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
10198 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
10199 recommended for better fairness.
10200
10201 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010202 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010203 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
10204 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
10205
10206 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
10207 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10208 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10209 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
10210 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
10211 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
10212 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
10213 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
10214 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
10215 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020010216
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020010217 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
10218 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010219 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
10220 reference it.
10221
10222 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
10223 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +010010224 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
10225 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
10226 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010227
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010228 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
10229 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
10230 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
10231 something that can be ignored.
10232
10233 Example:
10234 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
10235 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
10236 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
10237 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
10238
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +030010239 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.4
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +010010240 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010241
10242
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010243stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +010010244 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010245 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10246 no | no | yes | yes
10247
10248 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010249 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010250 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010251 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010252 server is selected.
10253
10254 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
10255 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
10256 the "stick-table" statement.
10257
10258 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
10259 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
10260 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
10261 when the response is a SSL server hello.
10262
10263 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
10264 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
10265 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
10266 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
10267 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
10268 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010269 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010270 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
10271 rules.
10272
10273 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
10274 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
10275 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
10276 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
10277 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
10278 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
10279 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
10280
10281 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
10282 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
10283 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
10284 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
10285
10286 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
10287 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
10288 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
10289 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
10290 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
10291 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010010292 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
10293 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
10294 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
10295 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
10296 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
10297 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
10298 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
10299 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
10300 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010301
10302 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
10303
10304 Example :
10305 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
10306 backend https
10307 mode tcp
10308 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010309 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010310 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010311
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010312 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
10313 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
10314
10315 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
10316 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
10317 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
10318
10319 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
10320 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010321
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010322 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
10323 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
10324 # at offset 44.
10325
10326 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
10327 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
10328
10329 # Learn on response if server hello.
10330 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010331
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010332 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
10333 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
10334
10335 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
10336 extraction.
10337
10338
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010339tcp-check comment <string>
10340 Defines a comment for the following the tcp-check rule, reported in logs if
10341 it fails.
10342 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10343 yes | no | yes | yes
10344
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010345 Arguments :
10346 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following tcp-check
10347 rule fails.
10348
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010349 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
10350 user-friendly error reporting.
10351
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010352 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send" and
10353 "tcp-check expect".
10354
10355
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010356tcp-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy] [via-socks4]
10357 [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020010358 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010359 Opens a new connection
10360 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010361 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010362
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010363 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010364 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
10365
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020010366 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Christopher Fauletbb591a12020-04-01 16:52:17 +020010367 checks. The server options are used only if not redifined.
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020010368
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020010369 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020010370 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
10371 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020010372 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020010373
10374 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010375
10376 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
10377
Christopher Faulet085426a2020-03-30 13:07:02 +020010378 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
10379
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010380 ssl opens a ciphered connection
10381
Christopher Faulet79b31d42020-03-30 13:00:05 +020010382 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
10383
Christopher Faulet98572322020-03-30 13:16:44 +020010384 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
10385 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
10386 for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
10387 If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
10388
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020010389 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
10390 It must be a TCP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
10391 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
10392 haproxy -vv.
10393
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020010394 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010395
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010396 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
10397 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
10398 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
10399
10400 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
10401 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
10402 of the sequence.
10403
10404 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
10405 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
10406 do.
10407
10408 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
10409 unset-var or comment rules.
10410
10411 Examples :
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010412 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
10413 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
10414 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
10415 option tcp-check
10416 tcp-check connect
10417 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
10418 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
10419 tcp-check send \r\n
10420 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
10421 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
10422 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
10423 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
10424 tcp-check send \r\n
10425 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
10426 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
10427
10428 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
10429 option tcp-check
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010430 tcp-check connect port 110 linger
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010431 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
10432 tcp-check connect port 143
10433 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
10434 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
10435
10436 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
10437
10438
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010439tcp-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020010440 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020010441 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020010442 [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010443 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010444 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010445 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010446
10447 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010448 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
10449
Gaetan Rivet1afd8262020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010450 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
10451 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
10452 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
10453 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
10454 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
10455 incomplete. If an exact string (string or binary) is used, the
10456 minimum between the string length and this parameter is used.
10457 This parameter is ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule
10458 does not match, the check will wait for more data. If set to 0,
10459 the evaluation result is always conclusive.
10460
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010461 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010462 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring", "binary" or
10463 "rbinary".
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010464 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
10465 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
10466 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
10467
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020010468 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
10469 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
10470 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020010471 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
10472 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
10473 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, for
10474 example 404 with disable-on-404
10475 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
10476 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020010477 By default "L7OK" is used.
10478
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020010479 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
10480 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020010481 "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are supported :
10482 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
10483 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
10484 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
10485 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
10486 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020010487
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020010488 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020010489 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020010490 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
10491 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
10492 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
10493 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020010494 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
10495
Christopher Fauletbe52b4d2020-04-01 16:30:22 +020010496 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
10497 informational message reported in logs if the expect
10498 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
10499 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
10500
10501 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
10502 informational message reported in logs if an error
10503 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
10504 log-format string.
10505
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020010506 status-code <expr> is optional and can be used to set the check status code
10507 reported in logs, on success or on error. <expr> is a
10508 standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10509 followed by some converters.
10510
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010511 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
10512 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
10513 with the usual backslash ('\').
10514 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010515 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010516 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
10517 used upper or lower case.
10518
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010519 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
10520
10521 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
10522 A health check response will be considered valid if the
10523 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
10524 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
10525 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
10526 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
10527 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
10528 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
10529
10530 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
10531 A health check response will be considered valid if the
10532 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
10533 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
10534 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
10535 expression.
10536
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020010537 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the response's buffer.
10538 A health check response will be considered valid if the
10539 response's buffer contains the string resulting of the
10540 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
10541 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
10542 considered invalid if the buffer contains the string.
10543
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010544 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
10545 in the response buffer. A health check response will
10546 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
10547 this exact hexadecimal string.
10548 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
10549
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010550 rbinary <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer, like
10551 "rstring". However, the response buffer is transformed
10552 into its hexadecimal form, including NUL-bytes. This
10553 allows using all regex engines to match any binary
10554 content. The hexadecimal transformation takes twice the
10555 size of the original response. As such, the expected
10556 pattern should work on at-most half the response buffer
10557 size.
10558
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020010559 binary-lf <hexfmt> : test a log-format string in its hexadecimal form
10560 match in the response's buffer. A health check response
10561 will be considered valid if the response's buffer
10562 contains the hexadecimal string resulting of the
10563 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format
10564 rules. If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
10565 considered invalid if the buffer contains the
10566 hexadecimal string. The hexadecimal string is converted
10567 in a binary string before matching the response's
10568 buffer.
10569
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010570 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
10571 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
10572 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
10573 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
10574 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
10575 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
10576 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
10577 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
10578 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
10579 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
10580 the null character.
10581
10582 Examples :
10583 # perform a POP check
10584 option tcp-check
10585 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
10586
10587 # perform an IMAP check
10588 option tcp-check
10589 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
10590
10591 # look for the redis master server
10592 option tcp-check
10593 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +020010594 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010595 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
10596 tcp-check expect string role:master
10597 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
10598 tcp-check expect string +OK
10599
10600
10601 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
10602 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
10603
10604
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010605tcp-check send <data> [comment <msg>]
10606tcp-check send-lf <fmt> [comment <msg>]
10607 Specify a string or a log-format string to be sent as a question during a
10608 generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010609 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010610 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010611
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010612 Arguments :
10613 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
10614
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010615 <data> is the string that will be sent during a generic health
10616 check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020010617
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010618 <fmt> is the log-format string that will be sent, once evaluated,
10619 during a generic health check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010620
10621 Examples :
10622 # look for the redis master server
10623 option tcp-check
10624 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
10625 tcp-check expect string role:master
10626
10627 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
10628 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
10629
10630
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010631tcp-check send-binary <hexstring> [comment <msg>]
10632tcp-check send-binary-lf <hexfmt> [comment <msg>]
10633 Specify an hex digits string or an hex digits log-format string to be sent as
10634 a binary question during a raw tcp health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010635 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010636 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010637
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010638 Arguments :
10639 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010640
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010641 <hexstring> is the hexadecimal string that will be send, once converted
10642 to binary, during a generic health check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020010643
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010644 <hexfmt> is the hexadecimal log-format string that will be send, once
10645 evaluated and converted to binary, during a generic health
10646 check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010647
10648 Examples :
10649 # redis check in binary
10650 option tcp-check
10651 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
10652 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
10653
10654
10655 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
10656 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
10657
10658
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010659tcp-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010660 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010661 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010662 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010663
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010664 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010665 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
10666 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
10667 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
10668 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
10669 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
10670 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
10671 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
10672 and '-'.
10673
10674 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
10675
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010676 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010677 tcp-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
10678
10679
10680tcp-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010681 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010682 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010683 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010684
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010685 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010686 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
10687 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
10688 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
10689 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
10690 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
10691 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
10692 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
10693 and '-'.
10694
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010695 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010696 tcp-check unset-var(check.port)
10697
10698
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010699tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10700 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020010701 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10702 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010703 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020010704 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10705 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020010706
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010707 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010708
10709 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
10710 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010711 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
10712 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
10713 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
10714 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
10715 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
10716 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010717
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010718 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
10719 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
10720 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
10721 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010722
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020010723 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010724 - accept :
10725 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10726 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
10727 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010728
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010729 - reject :
10730 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10731 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
10732 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
10733 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
10734 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
10735 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
10736 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
10737 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
10738 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
10739 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
10740 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010741 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010742
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010743 - expect-proxy layer4 :
10744 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
10745 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
10746 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
10747 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
10748 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
10749 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
10750 hosts.
10751
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010010752 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
10753 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
10754 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
10755 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
10756 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
10757 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
10758 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
10759 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
10760
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010761 - capture <sample> len <length> :
10762 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
10763 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
10764 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
10765 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
10766 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
10767 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
10768 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
10769 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020010770 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
10771 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010772
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010773 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010774 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020010775 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
10776 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
10777 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010778 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020010779 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
10780 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
10781 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
10782 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
10783 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
10784 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
10785 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
10786 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010787
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010788 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010789 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010790 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010791 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010792 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
10793 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
10794 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010795
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010796 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
10797 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
10798 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
10799 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010800
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010801 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
10802 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
10803 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
10804 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
10805 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010806 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
10807 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
10808 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
10809 layer7 information is extracted.
10810
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010811 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
10812 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
10813 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
10814 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
10815 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010816
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010817 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
10818 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
10819 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
10820 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
10821
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010822 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
10823 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
10824 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
10825 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
10826
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010010827 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }:
10828 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
10829 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
10830 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
10831 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010832
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010833 - set-src <expr> :
10834 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
10835 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
10836 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020010837 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010838
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020010839 Arguments:
10840 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10841 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010842
10843 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010844 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
10845
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010846 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
10847 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010848
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010849 - set-src-port <expr> :
10850 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
10851 expression.
10852
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020010853 Arguments:
10854 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10855 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010856
10857 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010858 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
10859
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010860 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
10861 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
10862 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010863
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020010864 - set-dst <expr> :
10865 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
10866 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
10867 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
10868 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
10869 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
10870
10871 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10872 followed by some converters.
10873
10874 Example:
10875
10876 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
10877 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
10878
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010879 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
10880 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
10881
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020010882 - set-dst-port <expr> :
10883 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
10884 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
10885 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
10886
10887
10888 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10889 followed by some converters.
10890
10891 Example:
10892
10893 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
10894
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010895 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
10896 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
10897 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
10898
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010899 - "silent-drop" :
10900 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010901 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010902 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
10903 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
10904 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
10905 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
10906 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010907 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
10908 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010909 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
10910 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010911 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010912 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
10913 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
10914 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
10915 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
10916
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010917 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10918 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10919 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010920
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010921 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
10922 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
10923 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010924
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010925 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010926 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010927 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010928
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010929 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
10930 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
10931 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010932
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010933 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010934 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
10935 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010936
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010937 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
10938
10939 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
10940
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010941 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10942
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010943 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010944
10945
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010946tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10947 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010948 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010949 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010950 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020010951 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10952 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010953
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010954 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010955
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010956 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010957 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
10958 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
10959 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
10960 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010961
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010962 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
10963 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
10964 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
10965 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010966 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
10967 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
10968 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
10969 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
10970 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
10971 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010972 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010973 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010974
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010975 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
10976 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
10977 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
10978 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010979
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010980 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010981 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010010982 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010983 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
10984 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040010985 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010986 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010987 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010988 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010010989 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020010990 - set-dst <expr>
10991 - set-dst-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010992 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010993 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010994 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010995 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010010996 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010997
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010998 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
10999 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010011000 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
11001 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011002
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010011003 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
11004 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
11005 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
11006 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
11007 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
11008 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011009
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011010 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011011 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11012 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011013
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011014 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020011015 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
11016 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
11017 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
11018 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010011019 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
11020 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
11021 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011022
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011023 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020011024 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
11025 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
11026 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011027
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020011028 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
11029 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
11030
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011031 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011032 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
11033 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011034
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011035 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
11036 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010011037 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011038 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
11039 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011040 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011041 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011042 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011043 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
11044 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011045 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010011046 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
11047 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011048
11049 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11050 followed by some converters.
11051
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011052 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
11053 <var-name>.
11054
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040011055 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
11056 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
11057 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
11058 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
11059 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
11060
11061 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
11062 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
11063 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
11064 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
11065 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
11066 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
11067 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
11068 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
11069 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
11070 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
11071 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
11072
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020011073 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
11074 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
11075 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
11076 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
11077 the SPOE agent name must be used.
11078
11079 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
11080
11081 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
11082
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010011083 The "use-service" is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the
11084 request and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to
11085 reply by sending any valid response or it may immediately close the
11086 connection without sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible
11087 to write your own services in Lua. No further "tcp-request" rules are
11088 evaluated.
11089
11090 Example:
11091 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
11092
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011093 Example:
11094
11095 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011096 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011097
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011098 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011099 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
11100 # and reject everything else.
11101 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
11102 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020011103 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011104 tcp-request content reject
11105
11106 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011107 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
11108 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
11109 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011110 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011111
11112 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
11113 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
11114 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011115 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011116 tcp-request content reject
11117
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011118 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011119 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011120 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020011121 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011122 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
11123 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011124
11125 Example:
11126 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
11127 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020011128 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011129
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011130 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011131 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011132
11133 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011134 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011135 # protecting all our sites
11136 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011137 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
11138 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011139 ...
11140 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
11141
11142 backend http_dynamic
11143 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011144 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011145 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011146 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011147 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011148 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011149 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011150
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011151 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011152
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030011153 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
11154 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011155
11156
11157tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
11158 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
11159 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020011160 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011161 Arguments :
11162 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11163 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11164 as explained at the top of this document.
11165
11166 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
11167 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
11168 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
11169 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
11170 data for at most the specified amount of time.
11171
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020011172 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
11173 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
11174 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
11175 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
11176
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011177 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
11178 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011179 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011180 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010011181 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
11182 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
11183 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
11184 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011185
11186 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
11187 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
11188 it pass through unaffected.
11189
11190 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
11191 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
11192 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011193 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011194 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
11195 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020011196 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
11197 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
11198 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011199
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011200 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011201 "timeout client".
11202
11203
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011204tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11205 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
11206 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11207 no | no | yes | yes
11208 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020011209 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11210 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011211
11212 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
11213
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011214 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011215 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
11216 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020011217 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
11218 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011219
11220 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
11221
11222 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
11223 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
11224 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
11225 inserted.
11226
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011227 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011228 - accept :
11229 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11230 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
11231 the rules evaluation.
11232
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020011233 - close :
11234 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
11235 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
11236 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
11237 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
11238 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
11239 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011240 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020011241 protocols.
11242
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011243 - reject :
11244 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11245 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011246 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011247
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011248 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
11249 Sets a variable.
11250
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011251 - unset-var(<var-name>)
11252 Unsets a variable.
11253
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020011254 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
11255 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
11256 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
11257 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
11258
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011259 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
11260 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
11261 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
11262 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
11263
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011264 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
11265 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
11266 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
11267 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
11268 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011269
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011270 - "silent-drop" :
11271 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011272 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011273 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
11274 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
11275 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
11276 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
11277 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011278 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
11279 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011280 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
11281 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011282 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011283 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
11284 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
11285 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
11286 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
11287
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020011288 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
11289 Send a group of SPOE messages.
11290
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011291 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
11292 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11293 for changing the default action to a reject.
11294
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011295 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
11296 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
11297 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
11298 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011299 period.
11300
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011301 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
11302 declared inline.
11303
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011304 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
11305 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010011306 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011307 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
11308 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011309 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011310 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011311 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011312 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
11313 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011314 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010011315 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
11316 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011317
11318 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11319 followed by some converters.
11320
11321 Example:
11322
11323 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
11324
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011325 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
11326 <var-name>.
11327
11328 Example:
11329
11330 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
11331
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020011332 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
11333 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
11334 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
11335 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
11336 the SPOE agent name must be used.
11337
11338 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
11339
11340 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
11341
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011342 See section 7 about ACL usage.
11343
11344 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
11345
11346
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011347tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11348 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
11349 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11350 no | yes | yes | no
11351 Arguments :
11352 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11353 below.
11354
11355 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
11356
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011357 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011358 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
11359 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
11360 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
11361 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
11362 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
11363 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
11364 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011365 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011366 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
11367 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
11368 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
11369 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
11370 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
11371 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
11372 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
11373 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
11374 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
11375 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
11376 instead.
11377
11378 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
11379 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
11380 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
11381 rules which may be inserted.
11382
11383 Several types of actions are supported :
11384 - accept : the request is accepted
11385 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
11386 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
11387 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011388 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011389 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011390 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011391 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011392 - silent-drop
11393
11394 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
11395 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
11396 sections for a complete description.
11397
11398 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
11399 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11400 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
11401
11402 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
11403 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
11404 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
11405 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
11406 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
11407
11408 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
11409 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
11410
11411 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
11412 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
11413 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
11414
11415 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
11416 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
11417 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
11418
11419 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
11420 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
11421 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
11422
11423 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
11424 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
11425 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
11426
11427 See section 7 about ACL usage.
11428
11429 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
11430
11431
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011432tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
11433 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
11434 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11435 no | no | yes | yes
11436 Arguments :
11437 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11438 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11439 as explained at the top of this document.
11440
11441 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
11442
11443
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011444timeout check <timeout>
11445 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
11446 established.
11447
11448 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11449 yes | no | yes | yes
11450 Arguments:
11451 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11452 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11453 as explained at the top of this document.
11454
11455 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
11456 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011457 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011458 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010011459 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
11460 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
11461 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011462
11463 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
11464 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
11465
11466 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
11467 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010011468 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011469
11470 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11471 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11472 forget about it.
11473
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010011474 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
11475 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011476
11477
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011478timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011479 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
11480 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11481 yes | yes | yes | no
11482 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011483 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011484 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11485 as explained at the top of this document.
11486
11487 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
11488 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
11489 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010011490 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
11491 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
11492 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
11493 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011494 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
11495 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
11496 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010011497 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011498 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011499 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
11500 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011501 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
11502 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011503
11504 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
11505 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11506 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
11507 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011508 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011509 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
11510
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011511 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010011512
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020011513 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011514
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011515
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011516timeout client-fin <timeout>
11517 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
11518 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11519 yes | yes | yes | no
11520 Arguments :
11521 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11522 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11523 as explained at the top of this document.
11524
11525 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
11526 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
11527 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
11528 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
11529 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
11530 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
11531 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010011532 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
11533 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
11534 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011535
11536 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
11537 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
11538 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
11539
11540 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
11541
11542
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011543timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011544 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
11545 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11546 yes | no | yes | yes
11547 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011548 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011549 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11550 as explained at the top of this document.
11551
11552 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010011553 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011554 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011555 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011556 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
11557 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011558
11559 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11560 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11561 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
11562 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011563 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011564 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
11565
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020011566 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011567
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011568
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011569timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
11570 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
11571 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11572 yes | yes | yes | yes
11573 Arguments :
11574 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11575 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11576 as explained at the top of this document.
11577
11578 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
11579 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
11580 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
11581 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
11582 once the request has started to present itself.
11583
11584 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
11585 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
11586 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
11587 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
11588 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
11589
11590 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
11591 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
11592 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
11593 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
11594
11595 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
11596 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011597 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011598 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
11599 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020011600 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011601
11602 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
11603 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
11604 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
11605 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
11606
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011607 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
11608 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010011609 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
11610
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011611 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
11612
11613
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011614timeout http-request <timeout>
11615 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
11616 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020011617 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011618 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011619 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011620 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11621 as explained at the top of this document.
11622
11623 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
11624 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
11625 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
11626 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
11627 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
11628 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
11629 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020011630 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
11631 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
11632 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
11633 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011634 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020011635 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
11636 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011637
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010011638 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
11639 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
11640 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
11641 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
11642 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011643 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011644
11645 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
11646 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011647 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011648 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
11649 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
11650
11651 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020011652 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
11653 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
11654 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011655
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020011656 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010011657 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011658
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011659
11660timeout queue <timeout>
11661 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
11662 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11663 yes | no | yes | yes
11664 Arguments :
11665 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11666 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11667 as explained at the top of this document.
11668
11669 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
11670 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
11671 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
11672 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
11673 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
11674
11675 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
11676 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
11677 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
11678 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
11679
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020011680 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011681
11682
11683timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011684 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
11685 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11686 yes | no | yes | yes
11687 Arguments :
11688 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11689 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11690 as explained at the top of this document.
11691
11692 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
11693 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
11694 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
11695 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
11696 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
11697 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
11698 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
11699
11700 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
11701 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
11702 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
11703 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
11704 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010011705 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011706 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011707 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
11708 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011709 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
11710 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011711
11712 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11713 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11714 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
11715 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011716 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011717 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
11718
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020011719 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011720
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011721
11722timeout server-fin <timeout>
11723 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
11724 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11725 yes | no | yes | yes
11726 Arguments :
11727 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11728 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11729 as explained at the top of this document.
11730
11731 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
11732 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
11733 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
11734 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
11735 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
11736 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
11737 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
11738 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
11739 situations, it should not be needed.
11740
11741 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11742 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
11743 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
11744
11745 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
11746
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011747
11748timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010011749 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011750 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11751 yes | yes | yes | yes
11752 Arguments :
11753 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
11754 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11755 as explained at the top of this document.
11756
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020011757 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
11758 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
11759 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011760
11761 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
11762 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
11763 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
11764 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010011765 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011766
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020011767 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011768
11769
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011770timeout tunnel <timeout>
11771 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
11772 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11773 yes | no | yes | yes
11774 Arguments :
11775 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11776 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11777 as explained at the top of this document.
11778
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011779 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011780 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
11781 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
11782 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011783 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
11784 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011785 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
11786 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
11787 specified.
11788
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011789 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
11790 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
11791 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
11792 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
11793 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
11794 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
11795 state.
11796
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011797 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
11798 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
11799 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
11800 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011801 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011802
11803 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11804 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11805 forget about it.
11806
11807 Example :
11808 defaults http
11809 option http-server-close
11810 timeout connect 5s
11811 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011812 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011813 timeout server 30s
11814 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
11815
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011816 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011817
11818
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011819transparent (deprecated)
11820 Enable client-side transparent proxying
11821 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010011822 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011823 Arguments : none
11824
11825 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
11826 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
11827 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
11828 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
11829 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
11830 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
11831 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
11832 appropriate server.
11833
11834 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
11835
11836 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
11837 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
11838
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011839 See also: "option transparent"
11840
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011841unique-id-format <string>
11842 Generate a unique ID for each request.
11843 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11844 yes | yes | yes | no
11845 Arguments :
11846 <string> is a log-format string.
11847
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011848 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
11849 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
11850 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
11851 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011852
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011853 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
11854 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
11855 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
11856 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
11857 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
11858 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
11859 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
11860 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011861
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011862 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
11863 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011864
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011865 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011866
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050011867 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011868
11869 will generate:
11870
11871 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
11872
11873 See also: "unique-id-header"
11874
11875unique-id-header <name>
11876 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
11877 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11878 yes | yes | yes | no
11879 Arguments :
11880 <name> is the name of the header.
11881
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011882 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
11883 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011884
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011885 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011886
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050011887 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011888 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
11889
11890 will generate:
11891
11892 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
11893
11894 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011895
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020011896use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020011897 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011898 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11899 no | yes | yes | no
11900 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010011901 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
11902 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011903
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020011904 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
11905 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011906
11907 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
11908 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
11909 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020011910 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011911 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020011912 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
11913 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011914
11915 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
11916 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
11917 assign the backend.
11918
11919 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
11920 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
11921 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
11922 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
11923 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
11924 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
11925
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020011926 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011927 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020011928 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
11929 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
11930 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
11931
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010011932 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
11933 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
11934 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
11935 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
11936 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
11937 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
11938 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
11939 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
11940 cannot be forced from the request.
11941
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011942 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010011943 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
11944 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
11945
11946 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
11947 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011948
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020011949use-fcgi-app <name>
11950 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
11951 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11952 no | no | yes | yes
11953 Arguments :
11954 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
11955
11956 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011957
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011958use-server <server> if <condition>
11959use-server <server> unless <condition>
11960 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
11961 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11962 no | no | yes | yes
11963 Arguments :
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020011964 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section
11965 or a "log-format" string resolving to a server name.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011966
11967 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
11968
11969 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
11970 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
11971 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
11972
11973 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
11974 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
11975 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
11976 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
11977 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
11978 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
11979 matches will assign the server.
11980
11981 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
11982 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
11983 with the next rules until one matches.
11984
11985 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
11986 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
11987 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
11988 according to other persistence mechanisms.
11989
11990 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
11991 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
11992 stripped.
11993
11994 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
11995 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
11996 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
11997 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
11998
11999 Example :
12000 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
12001 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
12002 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
12003 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
12004 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
12005 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000012006 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012007 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
12008 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
12009
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020012010 When <server> is a simple name, it is checked against existing servers in the
12011 configuration and an error is reported if the specified server does not exist.
12012 If it is a log-format, no check is performed when parsing the configuration,
12013 and if we can't resolve a valid server name at runtime but the use-server rule
12014 was conditionned by an ACL returning true, no other use-server rule is applied
12015 and we fall back to load balancing.
12016
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012017 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012018
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012019
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100120205. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012021--------------------------
12022
12023The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
12024depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
12025settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
12026written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
12027described in this section.
12028
12029
120305.1. Bind options
12031-----------------
12032
12033The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
12034as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
12035no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
12036parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
12037while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
12038provided immediately after the setting name.
12039
12040The currently supported settings are the following ones.
12041
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012042accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
12043 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
12044 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
12045 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
12046 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
12047 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
12048 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
12049 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
12050 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
12051 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010012052 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
12053 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
12054 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012055
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012056accept-proxy
12057 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020012058 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
12059 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012060 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
12061 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
12062 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
12063 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012064 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012065 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
12066 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020012067 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
12068 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012069
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020012070allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010012071 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010012072 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012073 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010012074 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
12075 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020012076
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012077alpn <protocols>
12078 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
12079 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
12080 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012081 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012082 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012083 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
12084 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
12085 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
12086 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
12087 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
12088 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
12089 preference, like below :
12090
12091 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012092
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012093backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010012094 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012095 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
12096
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010012097curves <curves>
12098 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
12099 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
12100 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
12101 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
12102 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
12103 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
12104
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020012105ecdhe <named curve>
12106 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010012107 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
12108 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020012109
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020012110ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020012111 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12112 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
12113 client's certificate.
12114
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020012115ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
12116 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
12117 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
12118 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
12119 error is ignored.
12120
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012121ca-sign-file <cafile>
12122 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12123 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
12124 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
12125 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
12126 'generate-certificates' for details.
12127
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000012128ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012129 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
12130 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
12131 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
12132 'generate-certificates' for details.
12133
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010012134ca-verify-file <cafile>
12135 This setting designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to
12136 verify client's certificate. It designates CA certificates which must not be
12137 included in CA names sent in server hello message. Typically, "ca-file" must
12138 be defined with intermediate certificates, and "ca-verify-file" with
12139 certificates to ending the chain, like root CA.
12140
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012141ciphers <ciphers>
12142 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
12143 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000012144 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012145 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012146 information and recommendations see e.g.
12147 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
12148 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
12149 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
12150
12151ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
12152 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
12153 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
12154 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
12155 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012156 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
12157 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012158
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020012159crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020012160 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12161 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
12162 to verify client's certificate.
12163
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012164crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012165 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12166 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
12167 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
12168 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
12169 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +010012170 file. Intermediate certificate can also be shared in a directory via
12171 "issuers-chain-path" directive.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012172
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +010012173 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load
12174 the key at the same path suffixed by a ".key".
12175
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012176 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
12177 are loaded.
12178
12179 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
William Lallemand3f25ae32020-02-24 16:30:12 +010012180 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends
12181 with '.key', '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This
12182 directive may be specified multiple times in order to load certificates from
12183 multiple files or directories. The certificates will be presented to clients
12184 who provide a valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their
12185 CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*'
12186 is used instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010012187 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012188
12189 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
12190 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
12191 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
12192 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010012193 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
12194 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012195
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020012196 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012197
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012198 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012199 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012200 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
12201 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012202 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
12203 clients).
12204
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020012205 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
12206 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
12207 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
12208 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
12209 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
12210 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
12211 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
12212 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
12213 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
12214 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
12215 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
12216 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
12217 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
12218
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010012219 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
12220 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
12221 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
12222 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
12223 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
12224
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050012225 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
12226 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
12227 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
12228 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012229
12230 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
12231 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
12232 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
12233 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
12234 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
12235 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
12236 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
12237 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
12238 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
12239
12240 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
12241
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050012242 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012243 a cert bundle.
12244
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012245 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012246 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
12247 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
12248 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
12249 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
12250 provide multi-cert support.
12251
12252 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
12253
12254 Filename | CN | SAN
12255 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
12256 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050012257 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012258 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
12259 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
12260
12261 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
12262 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
12263 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
12264 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020012265 suites. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is natively supported,
12266 no need to bundle certificates. ECDSA certificate will be preferred if client
12267 support it.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012268
12269 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
12270 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
12271
12272 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
12273 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
12274 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
12275
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020012276crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012277 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012278 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012279 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012280 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020012281
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012282crt-list <file>
12283 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012284 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
12285 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012286
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012287 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
12288
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010012289 sslbindconf support "npn", "alpn", "verify", "ca-file", "ca-verify-file",
12290 "no-ca-names", "crl-file", "ecdhe", "curves", "ciphers" configuration. With
12291 BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also
12292 supported. It override the configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012293
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020012294 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
12295 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
12296 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
12297 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
12298 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
12299 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
12300 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
12301 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012302
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050012303 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
Emmanuel Hocdetd294aea2016-05-13 11:14:06 +020012304 the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do the same work on
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020012305 all bundled certificates. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is
12306 natively supported, avoid multi-cert bundling. RSA and ECDSA certificates can
12307 be declared in a row, and set different ssl and filter parameter.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012308
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020012309 Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a hash ('#') will be ignored.
12310
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012311 crt-list file example:
12312 cert1.pem
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020012313 # comment
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010012314 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012315 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010012316 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012317
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012318defer-accept
12319 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
12320 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
12321 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012322 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012323 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
12324 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
12325 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
12326 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
12327 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
12328 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
12329 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
12330
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020012331expose-fd listeners
12332 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
12333 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020012334 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
12335 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012336 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020012337
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012338force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012339 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012340 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012341 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012342 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012343
12344force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012345 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012346 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012347 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012348
12349force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012350 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012351 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012352 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012353
12354force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012355 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012356 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012357 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012358
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012359force-tlsv13
12360 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
12361 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012362 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012363
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012364generate-certificates
12365 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12366 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
12367 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
12368 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
12369 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
12370 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
12371 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
12372 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
12373 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
12374 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
12375 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
12376
12377 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
12378 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012379 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012380 certificate is used many times.
12381
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012382gid <gid>
12383 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
12384 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
12385 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
12386 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
12387 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12388
12389group <group>
12390 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
12391 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
12392 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
12393 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
12394 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12395
12396id <id>
12397 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
12398 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
12399 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
12400 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
12401
12402interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010012403 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
12404 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
12405 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
12406 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
12407 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
12408 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010012409 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
12410 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
12411 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
12412 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
12413 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
12414 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012415
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012416level <level>
12417 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
12418 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
12419 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012420 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012421 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
12422 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
12423 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012424 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012425 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012426 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012427 all counters).
12428
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020012429severity-output <format>
12430 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
12431 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
12432 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
12433 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
12434 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
12435 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
12436 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
12437 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
12438 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
12439 rfc5424 convention.
12440
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012441maxconn <maxconn>
12442 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
12443 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
12444 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
12445 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
12446 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
12447 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
12448 eat all memory.
12449
12450mode <mode>
12451 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
12452 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
12453 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
12454 UNIX sockets.
12455
12456mss <maxseg>
12457 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
12458 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
12459 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
12460 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
12461 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
12462 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
12463 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
12464 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
12465 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
12466 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
12467 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
12468
12469name <name>
12470 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
12471 page.
12472
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020012473namespace <name>
12474 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
12475 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
12476 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
12477 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
12478
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012479nice <nice>
12480 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
12481 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
12482 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
12483 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
12484 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
12485 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
12486 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
12487 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
12488 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
12489 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
12490 one for an RDP socket.
12491
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020012492no-ca-names
12493 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12494 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010012495 Use "ca-verify-file" instead of "ca-file" with "no-ca-names".
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020012496
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012497no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012498 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012499 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012500 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012501 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012502 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
12503 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012504
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020012505no-tls-tickets
12506 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12507 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
12508 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012509 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
12510 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010012511 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
12512 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
12513 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020012514
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012515no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012516 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012517 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012518 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012519 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012520 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
12521 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012522
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012523no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012524 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012525 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012526 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012527 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012528 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
12529 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012530
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012531no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012532 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012533 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012534 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012535 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012536 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
12537 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012538
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012539no-tlsv13
12540 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12541 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
12542 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
12543 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012544 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
12545 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012546
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020012547npn <protocols>
12548 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
12549 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
12550 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012551 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012552 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012553 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
12554 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
12555 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
12556 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
12557 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020012558
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000012559prefer-client-ciphers
12560 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
12561 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
12562 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020012563 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
12564 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
12565 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000012566
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010012567process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010012568 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010012569 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012570 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010012571 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
12572 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
12573 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
12574 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012575 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010012576 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
12577 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
12578 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
12579 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
12580 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010012581
12582 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
12583
12584 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
12585 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
12586 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
12587 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
12588 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
12589 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
12590 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
12591 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020012592
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020012593proto <name>
12594 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
12595 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
12596 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
12597 in haproxy -vv.
12598 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
12599 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080012600 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020012601 h2" on the bind line.
12602
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012603ssl
12604 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012605 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012606 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
12607 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020012608 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
12609 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012610
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012611ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12612 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020012613 from this listener. Using this setting without "ssl-min-ver" can be
12614 ambiguous because the default ssl-min-ver value could change in future HAProxy
12615 versions. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012616 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
12617
12618ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020012619 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections
12620 instantiated from this listener. The default value is "TLSv1.2". This option
12621 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
12622 See also "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012623
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010012624strict-sni
12625 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
12626 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
12627 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
12628 See the "crt" option for more information.
12629
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010012630tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012631 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010012632 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
12633 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012634 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010012635 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
12636 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
12637 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
12638 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
12639 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
12640 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
12641 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
12642
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020012643tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010012644 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020012645 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
12646 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
12647 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
12648 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
12649 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
12650 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
12651 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020012652 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
12653 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
12654 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020012655
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010012656tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
12657 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010012658 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
12659 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
12660 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
12661 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
12662 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
12663 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
12664 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
12665 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
12666 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
12667 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010012668 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
12669 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
12670
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012671transparent
12672 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
12673 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
12674 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
12675 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
12676 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
12677 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
12678 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
12679 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
12680 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
12681 so check for support with your vendor.
12682
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010012683v4v6
12684 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
12685 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
12686 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
12687 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012688 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010012689
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010012690v6only
12691 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
12692 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
12693 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010012694 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
12695 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010012696
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012697uid <uid>
12698 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
12699 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
12700 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
12701 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
12702 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12703
12704user <user>
12705 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
12706 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
12707 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
12708 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
12709 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12710
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020012711verify [none|optional|required]
12712 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
12713 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
12714 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
12715 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
12716 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020012717 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
12718 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
12719 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
12720 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012721
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200127225.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010012723------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012724
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010012725The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
12726which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
12727arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
12728settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
12729after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
12730Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
12731address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012732
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012733 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010012734 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012735
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012736Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
12737keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
12738
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012739The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012740
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020012741addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012742 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010012743 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
12744 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
12745 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
12746 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
12747 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012748
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012749agent-check
12750 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012751 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010012752 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
12753 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
12754 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012755
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012756 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012757 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020012758 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
12759 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
12760 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012761
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012762 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
12763 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
12764 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
12765 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
12766 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020012767
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012768 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012769 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012770
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012771 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
12772 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
12773 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012774
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012775 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
12776 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
12777 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012778
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012779 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
12780 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
12781 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
12782 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
12783 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012784 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012785 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012786
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012787 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
12788 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012789
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012790 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
12791 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
12792 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
12793 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
12794 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
12795 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
12796 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
12797 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
12798 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012799
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090012800 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
12801 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012802 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
12803 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
12804 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010012805 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090012806
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012807 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012808 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012809
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070012810agent-send <string>
12811 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
12812 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
12813 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
12814 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
12815 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
12816
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012817agent-inter <delay>
12818 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
12819 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
12820
12821 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
12822 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
12823 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
12824 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
12825 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
12826 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
12827 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
12828 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
12829 of backends use the same servers.
12830
12831 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
12832
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010012833agent-addr <addr>
12834 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
12835
12836 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
12837 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
12838 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
12839 hostname, it will be resolved.
12840
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012841agent-port <port>
12842 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
12843
12844 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
12845
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020012846allow-0rtt
12847 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020012848 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
12849 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020012850
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012851alpn <protocols>
12852 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
12853 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
12854 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012855 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012856 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
12857 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
12858 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
12859 now obsolete NPN extension.
12860 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
12861 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
12862
12863 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
12864
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012865backup
12866 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
12867 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
12868 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
12869 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012870 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
12871 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012872
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012873ca-file <cafile>
12874 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12875 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
12876 server's certificate.
12877
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012878check
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020012879 This option enables health checks on a server:
12880 - when not set, no health checking is performed, and the server is always
12881 considered available.
12882 - when set and no other check method is configured, the server is considered
12883 available when a connection can be established at the highest configured
12884 transport layer. This means TCP by default, or SSL/TLS when "ssl" or
12885 "check-ssl" are set, both possibly combined with connection prefixes such
12886 as a PROXY protocol header when "send-proxy" or "check-send-proxy" are
12887 set.
12888 - when set and an application-level health check is defined, the
12889 application-level exchanges are performed on top of the configured
12890 transport layer and the server is considered available if all of the
12891 exchanges succeed.
12892
12893 By default, health checks are performed on the same address and port as
12894 configured on the server, using the same encapsulation parameters (SSL/TLS,
12895 proxy-protocol header, etc... ). It is possible to change the destination
12896 address using "addr" and the port using "port". When done, it is assumed the
12897 server isn't checked on the service port, and configured encapsulation
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +050012898 parameters are not reused. One must explicitly set "check-send-proxy" to send
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020012899 connection headers, "check-ssl" to use SSL/TLS.
12900
12901 When "sni" or "alpn" are set on the server line, their value is not used for
12902 health checks and one must use "check-sni" or "check-alpn".
12903
12904 The default source address for health check traffic is the same as the one
12905 defined in the backend. It can be changed with the "source" keyword.
12906
12907 The interval between checks can be set using the "inter" keyword, and the
12908 "rise" and "fall" keywords can be used to define how many successful or
12909 failed health checks are required to flag a server available or not
12910 available.
12911
12912 Optional application-level health checks can be configured with "option
12913 httpchk", "option mysql-check" "option smtpchk", "option pgsql-check",
12914 "option ldap-check", or "option redis-check".
12915
12916 Example:
12917 # simple tcp check
12918 backend foo
12919 server s1 192.168.0.1:80 check
12920 # this does a tcp connect + tls handshake
12921 backend foo
12922 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
12923 # simple tcp check is enough for check success
12924 backend foo
12925 option tcp-check
12926 tcp-check connect
12927 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012928
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020012929check-send-proxy
12930 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
12931 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
12932 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
12933 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
12934 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
12935 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
12936 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
12937
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010012938check-alpn <protocols>
12939 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
12940 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
12941 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
12942
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020012943check-proto <name>
12944 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the server's health-check
12945 connections. It must be compatible with the health-check type (TCP or
12946 HTTP). It must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available
12947 protocols is reported in haproxy -vv.
12948 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
12949 protocol for health-check connections established to this server.
12950 If not defined, the server one will be used, if set.
12951
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010012952check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020012953 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010012954 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
12955 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020012956
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012957check-ssl
12958 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
12959 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
12960 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
12961 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012962 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012963 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
12964 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012965 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012966 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
12967 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012968
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012969check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012970 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012971 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
12972 for normal traffic.
12973
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012974ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012975 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
12976 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
12977 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012978 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
12979 information and recommendations see e.g.
12980 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
12981 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
12982 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012983
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012984ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
12985 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
12986 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
12987 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
12988 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012989 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
12990 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
12991 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012992
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012993cookie <value>
12994 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
12995 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
12996 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
12997 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
12998 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
12999 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
13000 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
13001
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020013002crl-file <crlfile>
13003 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13004 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
13005 to verify server's certificate.
13006
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020013007crt <cert>
13008 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
13009 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
13010 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
13011 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
13012 certificate request.
13013
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020013014disabled
13015 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
13016 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
13017 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
13018 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
13019 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013020 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020013021
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013022enabled
13023 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
13024 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
13025 default value.
13026 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
13027 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020013028
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013029error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010013030 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
13031 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
13032 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013033
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013034 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013035
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013036fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013037 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
13038 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
13039 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
13040
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013041force-sslv3
13042 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
13043 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013044 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013045 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013046
13047force-tlsv10
13048 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013049 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013050 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013051
13052force-tlsv11
13053 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013054 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013055 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013056
13057force-tlsv12
13058 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013059 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013060 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013061
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013062force-tlsv13
13063 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
13064 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013065 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013066
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013067id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020013068 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
13069 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
13070 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013071
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013072init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
13073 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
13074 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013075 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013076 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
13077 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
13078 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
13079 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
13080 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
13081 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
13082 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
13083 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
13084 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013085 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013086 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
13087 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
13088 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
13089 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
13090 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
13091 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013092 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013093
13094 Example:
13095 defaults
13096 # never fail on address resolution
13097 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
13098
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013099inter <delay>
13100fastinter <delay>
13101downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013102 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
13103 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
13104 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
13105 between checks depending on the server state :
13106
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020013107 Server state | Interval used
13108 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
13109 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
13110 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
13111 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
13112 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
13113 or yet unchecked. |
13114 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
13115 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
13116 | "inter" otherwise.
13117 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013118
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013119 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
13120 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
13121 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
13122 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013123 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
13124 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
13125 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
13126 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
13127 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013128
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +020013129log-proto <logproto>
13130 The "log-proto" specifies the protocol used to forward event messages to
13131 a server configured in a ring section. Possible values are "legacy"
13132 and "octet-count" corresponding respectively to "Non-transparent-framing"
13133 and "Octet counting" in rfc6587. "legacy" is the default.
13134
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013135maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013136 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
13137 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010013138 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
13139 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013140 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
13141 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
13142 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
13143 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
13144
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010013145 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
13146 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
13147 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
13148 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
13149 than 50 concurrent requests.
13150
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013151maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013152 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
13153 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
13154 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
13155 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
13156 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
13157 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
13158 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
13159
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010013160max-reuse <count>
13161 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
13162 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
13163 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
13164 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
13165 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
13166 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
13167 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
13168 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
13169
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013170minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013171 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
13172 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
13173 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
13174 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
13175 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
13176 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013177 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013178 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013179
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020013180namespace <name>
13181 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
13182 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
13183 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
13184 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
13185
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013186no-agent-check
13187 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
13188 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13189 default value.
13190 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13191 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
13192
13193no-backup
13194 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
13195 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13196 default value.
13197 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13198 "default-server" "backup" setting.
13199
13200no-check
13201 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
13202 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13203 default value.
13204 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13205 "default-server" "check" setting.
13206
13207no-check-ssl
13208 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
13209 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13210 default value.
13211 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13212 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
13213
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013214no-send-proxy
13215 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
13216 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13217 default value.
13218 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13219 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
13220
13221no-send-proxy-v2
13222 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
13223 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13224 default value.
13225 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13226 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
13227
13228no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
13229 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
13230 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13231 default value.
13232 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13233 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
13234
13235no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
13236 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
13237 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13238 default value.
13239 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13240 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
13241
13242no-ssl
13243 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
13244 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13245 default value.
13246 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13247 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
13248
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010013249no-ssl-reuse
13250 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
13251 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
13252 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
13253 and for paranoid users.
13254
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013255no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013256 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
13257 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013258 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013259
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013260 Supported in default-server: No
13261
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020013262no-tls-tickets
13263 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13264 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
13265 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013266 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
13267 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010013268 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
13269 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
13270 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013271 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020013272
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013273no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013274 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013275 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13276 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013277 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13278 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013279 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013280
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013281 Supported in default-server: No
13282
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013283no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013284 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013285 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13286 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013287 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13288 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013289 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013290
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013291 Supported in default-server: No
13292
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013293no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013294 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013295 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13296 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013297 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13298 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013299 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013300
13301 Supported in default-server: No
13302
13303no-tlsv13
13304 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
13305 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13306 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
13307 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13308 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013309 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013310
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013311 Supported in default-server: No
13312
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013313no-verifyhost
13314 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
13315 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13316 default value.
13317 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13318 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013319
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020013320no-tfo
13321 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
13322 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13323 default value.
13324 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13325 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
13326
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090013327non-stick
13328 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
13329 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
13330 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
13331
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013332npn <protocols>
13333 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
13334 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
13335 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013336 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013337 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
13338 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
13339 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
13340
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013341observe <mode>
13342 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
13343 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
13344 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
13345 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
13346 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
13347 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010013348 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013349
13350 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
13351
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013352on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013353 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
13354 Currently, four modes are available:
13355 - fastinter: force fastinter
13356 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
13357 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
13358 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
13359 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
13360
13361 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
13362
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090013363on-marked-down <action>
13364 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
13365 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070013366 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
13367 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
13368 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
13369 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
13370 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
13371 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
13372 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
13373 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090013374
13375 Actions are disabled by default
13376
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070013377on-marked-up <action>
13378 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
13379 Currently one action is available:
13380 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
13381 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
13382 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
13383 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013384 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
13385 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070013386 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
13387 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
13388
13389 Actions are disabled by default
13390
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010013391pool-max-conn <max>
13392 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
13393 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
13394 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
13395 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
13396 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
13397 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
13398
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010013399pool-purge-delay <delay>
13400 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010013401 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020013402 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010013403
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013404port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013405 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
13406 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
13407 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
13408 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
13409 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
13410 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
13411
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020013412proto <name>
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020013413 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
13414 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
13415 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
13416 reported in haproxy -vv.
13417 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
13418 protocol for all connections established to this server.
13419
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013420redir <prefix>
13421 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
13422 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
13423 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
13424 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
13425 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
13426 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
13427 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
13428 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013429 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013430 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013431 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
13432 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
13433 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
13434 loop between the client and HAProxy!
13435
13436 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
13437
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013438rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013439 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
13440 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
13441 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
13442
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020013443resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
13444 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
13445 server.
13446
13447 Available options:
13448
13449 * allow-dup-ip
13450 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
13451 resolution at runtime is in operation.
13452 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
13453 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
13454 For such case, simply enable this option.
13455 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
13456
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050013457 * ignore-weight
13458 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
13459 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
13460 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
13461
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020013462 * prevent-dup-ip
13463 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
13464 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
13465 same fqdn.
13466 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
13467
13468 Example:
13469 backend b_myapp
13470 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
13471 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
13472 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
13473
13474 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
13475 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
13476 it
13477 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
13478 different address
13479
13480 Default value: not set
13481
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013482resolve-prefer <family>
13483 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
13484 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
13485 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
13486 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
13487
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020013488 Default value: ipv6
13489
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013490 Example:
13491
13492 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013493
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010013494resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013495 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010013496 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013497 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013498 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
13499 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010013500 configured network, another address is selected.
13501
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013502 Example:
13503
13504 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010013505
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013506resolvers <id>
13507 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
13508 hostname.
13509
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013510 Example:
13511
13512 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013513
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013514 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013515
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010013516send-proxy
13517 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
13518 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
13519 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
13520 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013521 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
13522 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
13523 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
13524 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
13525 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
13526 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
13527 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
13528 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
13529 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
13530 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013531 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
13532 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010013533
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013534send-proxy-v2
13535 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
13536 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
13537 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
13538 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020013539 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
13540 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
13541 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
13542 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013543
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010013544proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
Tim Duesterhuscf6e0c82020-03-13 12:34:24 +010013545 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add options to send in PROXY protocol
13546 version 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are:
13547
13548 - ssl : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl".
13549 - cert-cn : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn".
13550 - ssl-cipher: Name of the used cipher.
13551 - cert-sig : Signature algorithm of the used certificate.
13552 - cert-key : Key algorithm of the used certificate
13553 - authority : Host name value passed by the client (only SNI from a TLS
13554 connection is supported).
13555 - crc32c : Checksum of the PROXYv2 header.
13556 - unique-id : Send a unique ID generated using the frontend's
13557 "unique-id-format" within the PROXYv2 header.
13558 This unique-id is primarily meant for "mode tcp". It can
13559 lead to unexpected results in "mode http", because the
13560 generated unique ID is also used for the first HTTP request
13561 within a Keep-Alive connection.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010013562
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013563send-proxy-v2-ssl
13564 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
13565 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
13566 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
13567 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
13568 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
13569 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
13570 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013571 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
13572 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013573
13574send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
13575 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
13576 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
13577 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
13578 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
13579 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
13580 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
13581 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
13582 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013583 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
13584 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013585
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013586slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013587 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
13588 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
13589 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
13590 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
13591 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
13592 parameters :
13593
13594 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
13595 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
13596
13597 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
13598 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
13599 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
13600 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
13601
13602 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
13603 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
13604 seen as failed.
13605
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020013606sni <expression>
13607 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
13608 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
13609 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
13610 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020013611 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
13612 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020013613 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010013614 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
13615 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020013616
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020013617source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020013618source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020013619source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013620 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
13621 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
13622 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
13623 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
13624
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020013625 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
13626 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
13627 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
13628 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
13629 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
13630 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
13631 server.
13632
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000013633 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
13634 specifying the source address without port(s).
13635
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013636ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020013637 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
13638 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
13639 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
13640 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
13641 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
13642 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013643 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
13644 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013645
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013646ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
13647 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
13648 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
13649 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
13650
13651ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
13652 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
13653 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
13654 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
13655
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013656ssl-reuse
13657 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
13658 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13659 default value.
13660 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13661 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
13662
13663stick
13664 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
13665 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13666 default value.
13667 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13668 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013669
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080013670socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013671 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080013672 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
13673 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
13674
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020013675tcp-ut <delay>
13676 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
13677 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
13678 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013679 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020013680 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
13681 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
13682 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
13683 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
13684 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
13685 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
13686 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
13687 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
13688 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
13689
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010013690tfo
13691 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
13692 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
13693 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
13694 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
13695 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or haproxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020013696 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010013697
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013698track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020013699 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
13700 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
13701 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
13702 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013703 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
13704
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013705tls-tickets
13706 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
13707 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13708 default value.
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010013709 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
13710 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
13711 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013712 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
Bjoern Jacke5ab7eb62020-02-13 14:16:16 +010013713 "default-server" "no-tls-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013714
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020013715verify [none|required]
13716 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010013717 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020013718 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
13719 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013720 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020013721 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
13722 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
13723 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
13724 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
13725 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
13726 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
13727 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
13728 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020013729
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070013730verifyhost <hostname>
13731 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020013732 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
13733 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
13734 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
13735 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
13736 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
13737 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
13738 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
13739 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070013740
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013741weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013742 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
13743 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
13744 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020013745 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
13746 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
13747 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
13748 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
13749 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
13750 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013751
13752
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200137535.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
13754-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013755
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013756HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
13757using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
13758configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013759This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
13760can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
13761workload.
13762This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
13763resolution at run time.
13764Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
13765carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
13766
13767
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200137685.3.1. Global overview
13769----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013770
13771As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
13772different steps of the process life:
13773
13774 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
13775 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
13776 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
13777
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013778 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
13779 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013780
13781A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
13782 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
13783 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
13784 resolution to know this new IP.
13785
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013786When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013787HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013788SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
13789from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
13790will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
13791will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020013792
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013793A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013794 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013795 first valid response.
13796
13797 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
13798 servers return an error.
13799
13800
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200138015.3.2. The resolvers section
13802----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013803
13804This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013805HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
13806contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013807
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013808When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
13809uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
13810is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
13811answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
13812
13813When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013814used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013815
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013816 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
13817 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
13818 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013819
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013820 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
13821 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013822
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013823 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
13824 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
13825 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013826
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013827For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
13828following scenarios are possible:
13829
13830 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
13831 ignored
13832
13833 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
13834 applied
13835
13836 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
13837 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
13838
13839 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
13840 retries the query with a new type
13841
13842 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
13843 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013844
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013845As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
13846a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013847<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013848
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013849
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013850resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013851 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013852
13853A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
13854
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020013855accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013856 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013857 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020013858 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
13859 by RFC 6891)
13860
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020013861 Note: the maximum allowed value is 8192.
13862
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013863nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
13864 DNS server description:
13865 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
13866 <ip> : IP address of the server
13867 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
13868
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060013869parse-resolv-conf
13870 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
13871 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
13872 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
13873
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013874hold <status> <period>
13875 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
13876 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010013877 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013878 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013879 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
13880 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
13881 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
13882
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020013883 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013884
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013885resolve_retries <nb>
13886 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
13887 giving up.
13888 Default value: 3
13889
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013890 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
13891 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
13892 type.
13893
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013894timeout <event> <time>
13895 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
13896 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
13897 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010013898 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
13899 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013900 Default value: 1s
13901 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010013902 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013903 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013904 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
13905 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
13906
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013907 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013908
13909 resolvers mydns
13910 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
13911 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060013912 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013913 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013914 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013915 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010013916 hold other 30s
13917 hold refused 30s
13918 hold nx 30s
13919 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013920 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013921 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013922
13923
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200139246. Cache
13925---------
13926
13927HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
13928(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
13929RAM.
13930
13931The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
13932this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
13933
13934If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
13935independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
13936when we try to allocate a new one.
13937
13938The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
13939
13940It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
13941"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
13942for more details.
13943
13944When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
13945replaced by "<CACHE>".
13946
13947
139486.1. Limitation
13949----------------
13950
13951The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
13952
13953- If the response is not a 200
13954- If the response contains a Vary header
13955- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
13956- If the response is not cacheable
13957
13958- If the request is not a GET
13959- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
13960- If the request contains an Authorization header
13961
13962
139636.2. Setup
13964-----------
13965
13966To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
13967the corresponding http-request and response actions.
13968
13969
139706.2.1. Cache section
13971---------------------
13972
13973cache <name>
13974 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
13975 size of cache is mandatory.
13976
13977total-max-size <megabytes>
13978 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
13979 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
13980
13981max-object-size <bytes>
13982 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
13983 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
13984 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
13985
13986max-age <seconds>
13987 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set has the lowest
13988 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
13989 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
13990 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
13991 default.
13992
13993
139946.2.2. Proxy section
13995---------------------
13996
13997http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13998 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
13999 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
14000 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
14001 after this one.
14002
14003http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14004 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
14005 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
14006 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
14007 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
14008
14009
14010Example:
14011
14012 backend bck1
14013 mode http
14014
14015 http-request cache-use foobar
14016 http-response cache-store foobar
14017 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
14018
14019 cache foobar
14020 total-max-size 4
14021 max-age 240
14022
14023
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200140247. Using ACLs and fetching samples
14025----------------------------------
14026
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014027HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014028client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
14029The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
14030these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
14031but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
14032data called patterns.
14033
14034
140357.1. ACL basics
14036---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014037
14038The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
14039content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
14040from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
14041simple :
14042
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014043 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014044 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014045 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
14046 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014047
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014048The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
14049adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014050
14051In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
14052
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014053 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014054
14055This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
14056Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
14057and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014058an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
14059conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
14060as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
14061are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014062
14063ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
14064'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
14065which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
14066
14067There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
14068performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
14069
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014070The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
14071specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
14072this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014073methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
14074ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014075
14076Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
14077 - boolean
14078 - integer (signed or unsigned)
14079 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
14080 - string
14081 - data block
14082
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014083Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
14084converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
14085would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
14086The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
14087which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
14088
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014089Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
14090keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
14091fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
14092which are summarized in the table below :
14093
14094 +---------------------+-----------------+
14095 | Sample or converter | Default |
14096 | output type | matching method |
14097 +---------------------+-----------------+
14098 | boolean | bool |
14099 +---------------------+-----------------+
14100 | integer | int |
14101 +---------------------+-----------------+
14102 | ip | ip |
14103 +---------------------+-----------------+
14104 | string | str |
14105 +---------------------+-----------------+
14106 | binary | none, use "-m" |
14107 +---------------------+-----------------+
14108
14109Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
14110matching method, see below.
14111
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014112The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
14113 - boolean
14114 - integer or integer range
14115 - IP address / network
14116 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
14117 - regular expression
14118 - hex block
14119
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014120The following ACL flags are currently supported :
14121
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014122 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
14123 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014124 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010014125 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010014126 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010014127 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014128 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
14129
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014130The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
14131read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
14132if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
14133lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
14134will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
14135beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
14136a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
14137lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
14138exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
14139
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010014140The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
14141parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
14142ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
14143a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
14144check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
14145
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010014146The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
14147socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
14148file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
14149
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014150Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
14151loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
14152
14153 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
14154
14155In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
14156the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
14157case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
14158as well.
14159
14160The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
14161sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
14162do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
14163methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
14164is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014165obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014166followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
14167default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
14168that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
14169string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
14170
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010014171The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
14172By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
14173string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
14174resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
14175server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014176waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010014177flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
14178function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
14179
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014180There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
14181sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
14182be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014183
14184 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
14185 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014186 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
14187 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
14188 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
14189 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014190
14191 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
14192 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014193 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014194
14195 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014196 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014197
14198 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014199 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014200
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014201 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014202 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
14203
14204 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
14205 binary or string samples.
14206
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014207 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
14208 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014209
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014210 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
14211 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
14212 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014213
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014214 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
14215 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014216
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014217 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
14218 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014219
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014220 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
14221 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014222
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014223 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
14224 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014225 This may be used with binary or string samples.
14226
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014227 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
14228 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
14229 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014230
14231For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
14232request, it is possible to do :
14233
14234 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
14235
14236In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
14237buffer, one would use the following acl :
14238
14239 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
14240
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014241On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
14242possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
14243
14244 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
14245
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014246All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
14247criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
14248method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
14249to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
14250criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
14251the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014252
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014253If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014254the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
14255For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014256
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014257 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
14258 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
14259 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
14260 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014261
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014262
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014263The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
14264types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
14265combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
14266brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
14267default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014268
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014269 +-------------------------------------------------+
14270 | Input sample type |
14271 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014272 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014273 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
14274 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
14275 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014276 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014277 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014278 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014279 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014280 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014281 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014282 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014283 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014284 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014285 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014286 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014287 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014288 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014289 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014290 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014291 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014292 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014293 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014294 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014295 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014296 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014297 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
14298 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
14299 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014300
14301
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200143027.1.1. Matching booleans
14303------------------------
14304
14305In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
14306Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
14307When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
14308that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
14309
14310Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
14311return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
14312"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
14313
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014314
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200143157.1.2. Matching integers
14316------------------------
14317
14318Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
14319enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
14320to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
14321
14322Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
14323matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
14324lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014325
14326For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
14327unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
14328representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
14329
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014330As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
14331two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
14332instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
14333ranges and operators.
14334
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014335For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014336operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
14337Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
14338of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014339
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014340Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014341
14342 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
14343 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
14344 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
14345 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
14346 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
14347
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014348For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014349
14350 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
14351
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014352This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
14353
14354 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
14355
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014356
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200143577.1.3. Matching strings
14358-----------------------
14359
14360String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
14361different forms :
14362
14363 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014364 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014365
14366 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014367 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014368
14369 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
14370 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
14371
14372 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
14373 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
14374
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010014375 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014376 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
14377 matches.
14378
14379 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
14380 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
14381 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014382
14383String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
14384exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
14385characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
14386string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
14387to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014388before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014389
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010014390Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
14391(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
14392Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
14393
14394Example:
14395 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
14396 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
14397
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014398
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200143997.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
14400---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014401
14402Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
14403they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
14404possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
14405passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
14406the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014407the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
14408match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014409
14410
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200144117.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
14412-------------------------------------
14413
14414It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
14415not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
14416a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
14417to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
14418digits may be used upper or lower case.
14419
14420Example :
14421 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
14422 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
14423
14424
144257.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
14426---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014427
14428IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
14429netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
14430within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010014431host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014432difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
14433at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
14434does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
14435parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014436
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020014437The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
14438abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
14439
14440 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
14441 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
14442 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
14443 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
14444 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
14445 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
14446 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
14447 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
14448
14449Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
14450192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
14451
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020014452IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
14453Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
14454trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
14455IPv6 patterns.
14456
14457HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
14458following situations :
14459 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
14460 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
14461 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
14462 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
14463 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
14464 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
14465 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
14466 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
14467 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
14468 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
14469
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014470
144717.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
14472----------------------------------
14473
14474Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
14475combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
14476
14477 - AND (implicit)
14478 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
14479 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014480
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014481A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014482
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014483 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020014484
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014485Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
14486indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020014487
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014488For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
14489"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
14490requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
14491is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
14492
14493 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030014494 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
14495 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
14496 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014497
14498To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
14499and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
14500
14501 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
14502 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
14503 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
14504 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
14505
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014506 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014507 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
14508 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
14509 use_backend www if host_www
14510
14511It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
14512expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
14513be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
14514the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
14515
14516 The following rule :
14517
14518 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030014519 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014520
14521 Can also be written that way :
14522
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030014523 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014524
14525It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
14526to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
14527simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
14528sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
14529good use is the following :
14530
14531 With named ACLs :
14532
14533 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
14534 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
14535 monitor fail if site_dead
14536
14537 With anonymous ACLs :
14538
14539 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
14540
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030014541See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
14542keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014543
14544
145457.3. Fetching samples
14546---------------------
14547
14548Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
14549against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
14550sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
14551ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
14552of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
14553available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
14554
14555This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
14556Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
14557compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
14558deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
14559
14560The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
14561matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
14562method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
14563indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
14564
14565As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
14566when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
14567mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
14568the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
14569ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
14570
14571Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
14572multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
14573when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014574incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
14575are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014576is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
14577all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
14578
14579Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
14580 - name
14581 - name(arg1)
14582 - name(arg1,arg2)
14583
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014584
145857.3.1. Converters
14586-----------------
14587
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014588Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
14589of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
14590is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
14591was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014592has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014593unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
14594
14595These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
14596sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
14597the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014598support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014599
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014600A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
14601support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
14602supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
14603(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
14604bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
14605
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014606The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014607
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001460851d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
14609 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
14610 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
14611 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
14612 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
14613 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
14614
14615 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014616 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
14617 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000014618 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
14619 frontend http-in
14620 bind *:8081
14621 default_backend servers
14622 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
14623 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
14624
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014625add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014626 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014627 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014628 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
14629 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014630 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014631 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14632 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14633 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14634 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014635 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014636 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014637
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010014638aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
14639 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
14640 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
14641 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
14642 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
14643 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
14644 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
14645
14646 Example:
14647 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
14648 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
14649
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014650and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014651 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014652 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014653 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
14654 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014655 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014656 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14657 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14658 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14659 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014660 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014661 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014662
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020014663b64dec
14664 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
14665 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
14666
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020014667base64
14668 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014669 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020014670 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
14671
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014672bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014673 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014674 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014675 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014676 presence of a flag).
14677
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010014678bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
14679 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
14680 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014681 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010014682
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010014683concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
14684 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
14685 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
14686 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
14687 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
14688 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
14689 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
14690 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
14691 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
14692 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
14693 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010014694 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. If commas or closing
14695 parethesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
14696 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
14697 level parser. See examples below.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010014698
14699 Example:
14700 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
14701 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
14702 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010014703 tcp-request session set-var(txn.ipport) "str(),concat('addr=(',sess.ip),concat(',',sess.port,')')"
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010014704 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
14705
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014706cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014707 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
14708 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014709
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010014710crc32([<avalanche>])
14711 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
14712 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14713 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14714 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14715 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14716 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
14717 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
14718 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
14719 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
14720 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014721 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
14722
14723crc32c([<avalanche>])
14724 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
14725 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14726 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14727 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
14728 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
14729 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
14730 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
14731 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010014732
Christopher Fauletea159d62020-04-01 16:21:44 +020014733cut_crlf
14734 Cuts the string representation of the input sample on the first carriage
14735 return ('\r') or newline ('\n') character found. Only the string length is
14736 updated.
14737
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010014738da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020014739 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
14740 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
14741 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
14742 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000014743 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020014744 configuration language.
14745
14746 Example:
14747 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020014748 bind *:8881
14749 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000014750 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020014751
Willy Tarreau0851fd52019-12-17 10:07:25 +010014752debug([<prefix][,<destination>])
14753 This converter is used as debug tool. It takes a capture of the input sample
14754 and sends it to event sink <destination>, which may designate a ring buffer
14755 such as "buf0", as well as "stdout", or "stderr". Available sinks may be
14756 checked at run time by issuing "show events" on the CLI. When not specified,
14757 the output will be "buf0", which may be consulted via the CLI's "show events"
14758 command. An optional prefix <prefix> may be passed to help distinguish
14759 outputs from multiple expressions. It will then appear before the colon in
14760 the output message. The input sample is passed as-is on the output, so that
14761 it is safe to insert the debug converter anywhere in a chain, even with non-
14762 printable sample types.
14763
14764 Example:
14765 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src,debug(track-sc)
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020014766
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020014767digest(<algorithm>)
14768 Converts a binary input sample to a message digest. The result is a binary
14769 sample. The <algorithm> must be an OpenSSL message digest name (e.g. sha256).
14770
14771 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
14772 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
14773
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014774div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014775 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
14776 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014777 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014778 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
14779 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014780 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014781 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14782 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14783 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14784 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014785 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014786 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014787
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014788djb2([<avalanche>])
14789 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
14790 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14791 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14792 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14793 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14794 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
14795 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014796 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
14797 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014798
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014799even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014800 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014801 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
14802
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020014803field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
14804 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
14805 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
14806 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
14807 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
14808 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
14809 fields.
14810
14811 Example :
14812 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
14813 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
14814 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
14815 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
14816 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010014817
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014818hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014819 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014820 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014821 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014822 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010014823
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020014824hex2i
14825 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014826 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020014827
Christopher Faulet4ccc12f2020-04-01 09:08:32 +020014828htonl
14829 Converts the input integer value to its 32-bit binary representation in the
14830 network byte order. Because sample fetches own signed 64-bit integer, when
14831 this converter is used, the input integer value is first casted to an
14832 unsigned 32-bit integer.
14833
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020014834hmac(<algorithm>, <key>)
14835 Converts a binary input sample to a message authentication code with the given
14836 key. The result is a binary sample. The <algorithm> must be one of the
14837 registered OpenSSL message digest names (e.g. sha256). The <key> parameter must
14838 be base64 encoded and can either be a string or a variable.
14839
14840 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
14841 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
14842
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010014843http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014844 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
14845 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000014846 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
14847 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
14848 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
14849 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
14850 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
14851 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
14852 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
14853 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014854
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014855in_table(<table>)
14856 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14857 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
14858 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014859 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014860 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
14861
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010014862ipmask(<mask4>, [<mask6>])
14863 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014864 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010014865 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
14866 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
14867 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
14868 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
14869 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014870
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014871json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014872 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014873 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020014874 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014875 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
14876 of errors:
14877 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
14878 bytes, ...)
14879 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
14880 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
14881
14882 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
14883 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
14884 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
14885 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
14886 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
14887 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014888 - "ascii" : never fails;
14889 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
14890 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014891 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014892 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014893 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
14894 characters corresponding to the other errors.
14895
14896 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014897 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014898
14899 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014900 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020014901 capture request header user-agent len 150
14902 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014903
14904 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
14905 GET / HTTP/1.0
14906 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
14907
14908 Output log:
14909 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
14910
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014911language(<value>[,<default>])
14912 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
14913 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
14914 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
14915 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
14916 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
14917 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
14918 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
14919 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
14920 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014921 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014922 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
14923 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014924
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014925 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014926
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014927 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
14928 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014929
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014930 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
14931 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
14932 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
14933 use_backend spanish if es
14934 use_backend french if fr
14935 use_backend english if en
14936 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014937
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010014938length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010014939 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
14940 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
14941 type. The result is of type integer.
14942
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014943lower
14944 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
14945 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
14946 type. The result is of type string.
14947
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014948ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
14949 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
14950 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
14951 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
14952 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
14953 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
14954 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
14955
14956 Example :
14957
14958 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014959 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014960 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
14961
Christopher Faulet51fc9d12020-04-01 17:24:41 +020014962ltrim(<chars>)
14963 Skips any characters from <chars> from the beginning of the string
14964 representation of the input sample.
14965
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014966map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
14967map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
14968map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
14969 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
14970 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
14971 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
14972 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
14973 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
14974 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
14975 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
14976 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014977
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014978 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
14979 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
14980 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014981
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014982 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014983 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014984
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014985 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
14986 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14987 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
14988 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020014989 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
14990 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014991 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
14992 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14993 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
14994 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14995 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
14996 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14997 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
14998 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080014999 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
15000 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15001 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015002 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15003 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
15004 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15005 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
15006 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015007
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010015008 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
15009 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
15010 the corresponding match text.
15011
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015012 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
15013 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
15014 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
15015 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
15016 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015017
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015018 Example :
15019
15020 # this is a comment and is ignored
15021 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
15022 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
15023 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
15024 | | | `---------- value
15025 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
15026 | `---------------------------- key
15027 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
15028
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015029mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015030 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
15031 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015032 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015033 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015034 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015035 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15036 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15037 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15038 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015039 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015040 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015041
15042mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015043 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020015044 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
15045 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015046 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015047 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015048 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015049 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15050 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15051 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15052 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015053 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015054 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015055
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010015056nbsrv
15057 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
15058 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
15059 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
15060 map lookup.
15061
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015062neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015063 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
15064 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
15065 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
15066 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015067
15068not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015069 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015070 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015071 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015072 absence of a flag).
15073
15074odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015075 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015076 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
15077
15078or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015079 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015080 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015081 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
15082 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015083 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015084 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15085 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15086 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15087 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015088 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015089 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015090
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010015091protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
15092 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
15093 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
15094 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
15095 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
15096 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
15097 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
15098 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
15099 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
15100 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
15101 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
15102 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
15103
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010015104regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015105 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
15106 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
15107 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
15108 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
15109 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
15110 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
15111 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
15112 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
15113 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015114 The first use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence
15115 of characters with other ones.
15116
15117 It is highly recommended to enclose the regex part using protected quotes to
15118 improve clarity and never have a closing parenthesis from the regex mixed up
15119 with the parenthesis from the function. Just like in Bourne shell, the first
15120 level of quotes is processed when delimiting word groups on the line, a
15121 second level is usable for argument. It is recommended to use single quotes
15122 outside since these ones do not try to resolve backslashes nor dollar signs.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015123
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010015124 Examples:
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015125
15126 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
15127 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
15128 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015129 http-request set-header x-path "%[hdr(x-path),regsub('/+','/','g')]"
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015130
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010015131 # copy query string to x-query and drop all leading '?', ';' and '&'
15132 http-request set-header x-query "%[query,regsub([?;&]*,'')]"
15133
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010015134 # capture groups and backreferences
15135 # both lines do the same.
15136 http-request redirect location %[url,'regsub("(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?","\2\1",i)]'
15137 http-request redirect location %[url,regsub(\"(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?\",\"\2\1\",i)]
15138
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020015139capture-req(<id>)
15140 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
15141 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
15142
15143 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020015144 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
15145 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020015146
15147capture-res(<id>)
15148 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
15149 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
15150
15151 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020015152 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
15153 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020015154
Christopher Faulet568415a2020-04-01 17:24:47 +020015155rtrim(<chars>)
15156 Skips any characters from <chars> from the end of the string representation
15157 of the input sample.
15158
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015159sdbm([<avalanche>])
15160 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
15161 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15162 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15163 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
15164 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
15165 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
15166 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010015167 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
15168 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015169
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020015170secure_memcmp(<var>)
15171 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value. Both values are treated
15172 as a binary string. Returns a boolean indicating whether both binary strings
15173 match.
15174
15175 If both binary strings have the same length then the comparison will be
15176 performed in constant time.
15177
15178 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
15179 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
15180
15181 Example :
15182
15183 http-request set-var(txn.token) hdr(token)
15184 # Check whether the token sent by the client matches the secret token
15185 # value, without leaking the contents using a timing attack.
15186 acl token_given str(my_secret_token),secure_memcmp(txn.token)
15187
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015188set-var(<var name>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015189 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
15190 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
15191 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015192 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015193 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15194 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015195 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015196 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15197 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015198 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015199 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015200
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020015201sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020015202 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020015203 sample with length of 20 bytes.
15204
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020015205sha2([<bits>])
15206 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
15207 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
15208
15209 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
15210 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
15211
15212 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
15213 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
15214
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020015215srv_queue
15216 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
15217 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
15218 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
15219 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
15220 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
15221
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020015222strcmp(<var>)
15223 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
15224 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
15225 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
15226 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
15227 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
15228 shorter).
15229
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020015230 See also the secure_memcmp converter if you need to compare two binary
15231 strings in constant time.
15232
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020015233 Example :
15234
15235 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
15236 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
15237 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
15238
15239
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015240sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015241 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
15242 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015243 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015244 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
15245 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015246 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015247 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15248 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015249 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015250 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15251 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015252 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015253 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015254
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015255table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
15256 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15257 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15258 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
15259 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
15260 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
15261 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
15262
15263
15264table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
15265 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15266 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15267 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
15268 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
15269 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
15270 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
15271
15272table_conn_cnt(<table>)
15273 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15274 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015275 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015276 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
15277 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
15278
15279table_conn_cur(<table>)
15280 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15281 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15282 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
15283 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
15284 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
15285
15286table_conn_rate(<table>)
15287 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15288 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15289 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
15290 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
15291 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
15292
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020015293table_gpt0(<table>)
15294 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15295 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
15296 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
15297 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
15298 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
15299
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015300table_gpc0(<table>)
15301 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15302 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15303 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
15304 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
15305 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
15306
15307table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
15308 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15309 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15310 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
15311 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
15312 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
15313 sample fetch keyword.
15314
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015315table_gpc1(<table>)
15316 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15317 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15318 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
15319 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
15320 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
15321
15322table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
15323 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15324 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15325 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
15326 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
15327 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
15328 sample fetch keyword.
15329
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015330table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
15331 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15332 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015333 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015334 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
15335 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
15336
15337table_http_err_rate(<table>)
15338 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15339 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15340 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
15341 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
15342 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
15343 keyword.
15344
15345table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
15346 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15347 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015348 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015349 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
15350 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
15351
15352table_http_req_rate(<table>)
15353 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15354 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15355 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
15356 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
15357 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
15358 keyword.
15359
15360table_kbytes_in(<table>)
15361 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15362 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015363 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015364 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
15365 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
15366 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
15367 keyword.
15368
15369table_kbytes_out(<table>)
15370 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15371 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015372 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015373 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
15374 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
15375 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
15376 keyword.
15377
15378table_server_id(<table>)
15379 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15380 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15381 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
15382 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
15383 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
15384 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
15385
15386table_sess_cnt(<table>)
15387 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15388 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015389 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015390 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
15391 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
15392 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
15393 keyword.
15394
15395table_sess_rate(<table>)
15396 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15397 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15398 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
15399 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
15400 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
15401 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
15402 keyword.
15403
15404table_trackers(<table>)
15405 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15406 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15407 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
15408 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
15409 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
15410 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
15411 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
15412 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
15413 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
15414 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
15415
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020015416upper
15417 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
15418 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
15419 type. The result is of type string.
15420
Willy Tarreau62ba9ba2020-04-23 17:54:47 +020015421url_dec([<in_form>])
15422 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded version
15423 as output. The input and the output are of type string. If the <in_form>
15424 argument is set to a non-zero integer value, the input string is assumed to
15425 be part of a form or query string and the '+' character will be turned into a
15426 space (' '). Otherwise this will only happen after a question mark indicating
15427 a query string ('?').
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020015428
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015429ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010015430 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010015431 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
15432 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
15433 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015434 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
15435 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
15436 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
15437 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015438 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015439 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
15440 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010015441
15442 Example:
15443 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
15444 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
15445
15446 message Point {
15447 int32 latitude = 1;
15448 int32 longitude = 2;
15449 }
15450
15451 message PPoint {
15452 Point point = 59;
15453 }
15454
15455 message Rectangle {
15456 // One corner of the rectangle.
15457 PPoint lo = 48;
15458 // The other corner of the rectangle.
15459 PPoint hi = 49;
15460 }
15461
15462 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
15463 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
15464 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
15465
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015466 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
15467 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015468 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015469 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
15470
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015471 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015472
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015473 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015474
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015475 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010015476 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
15477 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
15478
15479 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
15480 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
15481 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
15482
15483 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
15484 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
15485 interpret the previous binary sample.
15486
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010015487
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010015488unset-var(<var name>)
15489 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
15490 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
15491 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
15492 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15493 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
15494 response),
15495 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15496 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
15497 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
15498 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
15499
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020015500utime(<format>[,<offset>])
15501 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
15502 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
15503 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
15504 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
15505 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
15506 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
15507
15508 Example :
15509
15510 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015511 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020015512 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
15513
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020015514word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
15515 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
15516 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
15517 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010015518 Delimiters at the beginning or end of the input string are ignored.
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020015519 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
15520 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
15521
15522 Example :
15523 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
15524 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
15525 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
15526 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
15527 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010015528 str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f1
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010015529
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015530wt6([<avalanche>])
15531 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
15532 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15533 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15534 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
15535 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
15536 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
15537 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010015538 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
15539 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015540
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015541xor(<value>)
15542 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015543 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015544 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015545 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015546 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015547 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15548 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015549 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015550 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15551 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015552 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015553 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015554
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010015555xxh32([<seed>])
15556 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
15557 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
15558 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
15559 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
15560 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
15561 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
15562 as cryptographically secure.
15563
15564xxh64([<seed>])
15565 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
15566 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
15567 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
15568 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
15569 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
15570 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
15571 as cryptographically secure.
15572
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015573
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200155747.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015575--------------------------------------------
15576
15577A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
15578not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
15579"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
15580The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
15581
15582always_false : boolean
15583 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
15584 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
15585
15586always_true : boolean
15587 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
15588 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
15589
15590avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015591 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015592 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
15593 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
15594 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
15595 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
15596 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
15597 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
15598 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
15599 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
15600 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
15601 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
15602 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
15603 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
15604 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010015605
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015606be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020015607 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
15608 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
15609 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
15610 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040015611 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
15612
15613be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
15614 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
15615 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
15616 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
15617 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
15618 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040015619 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
15620 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040015621
15622 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
15623 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
15624 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015625
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015626be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
15627 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
15628 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
15629 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015630 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015631 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
15632 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015633
15634 Example :
15635 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
15636 backend dynamic
15637 mode http
15638 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
15639 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015640
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015641bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020015642 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
15643 of the string.
15644
15645bool(<bool>) : bool
15646 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
15647 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
15648
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015649connslots([<backend>]) : integer
15650 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015651 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015652 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
15653 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050015654
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080015655 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015656 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080015657 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
15658
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015659 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
15660 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080015661
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020015662 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015663 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015664 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015665 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015666 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015667 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020015668 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080015669
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015670 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
15671 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015672 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015673 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080015674
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010015675cpu_calls : integer
15676 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
15677 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
15678 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
15679 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
15680 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
15681 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
15682
15683cpu_ns_avg : integer
15684 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
15685 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
15686 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
15687 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
15688 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
15689 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
15690 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
15691 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
15692 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
15693 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
15694 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
15695
15696cpu_ns_tot : integer
15697 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
15698 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
15699 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
15700 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
15701 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
15702 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
15703 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
15704 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
15705 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
15706 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
15707 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
15708 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
15709 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
15710
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010015711date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020015712 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000015713
15714 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
15715 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
15716 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020015717 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
15718
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000015719 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
15720 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
15721 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
15722 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
15723 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
15724
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020015725 Example :
15726
15727 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
15728 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020015729
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000015730 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
15731 # millisecond granularity
15732 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
15733
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010015734date_us : integer
15735 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
15736 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
15737 from the same timeval structure.
15738
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020015739distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
15740 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
15741 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
15742 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
15743 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
15744 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
15745 list of supported tokens.
15746
15747distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
15748 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
15749 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
15750 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
15751 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
15752 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
15753 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
15754 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
15755 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
15756 supported tokens.
15757
15758 Example :
15759 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
15760 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
15761 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
15762 # send large files to the big farm
15763 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
15764
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020015765env(<name>) : string
15766 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
15767 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
15768 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
15769 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
15770 certain way.
15771
15772 Examples :
15773 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
15774 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
15775
15776 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
15777 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
15778
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015779fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
15780 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015781 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
15782 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015783 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
15784 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015785 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015786 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
15787 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020015788
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020015789fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
15790 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
15791 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
15792 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
15793
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015794fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
15795 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
15796 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
15797 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
15798 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
15799 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
15800 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
15801 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
15802 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010015803
15804 Example :
15805 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
15806 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
15807 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
15808 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
15809 frontend mail
15810 bind :25
15811 mode tcp
15812 maxconn 100
15813 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
15814 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
15815 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
15816 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015817
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010015818hostname : string
15819 Returns the system hostname.
15820
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015821int(<integer>) : signed integer
15822 Returns a signed integer.
15823
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020015824ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
15825 Returns an ipv4.
15826
15827ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
15828 Returns an ipv6.
15829
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010015830lat_ns_avg : integer
15831 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
15832 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
15833 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
15834 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
15835 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
15836 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
15837 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
15838 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
15839 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
15840 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
15841 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
15842 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
15843 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex.
15844 Note: this value is exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
15845
15846lat_ns_tot : integer
15847 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
15848 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
15849 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
15850 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
15851 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
15852 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
15853 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
15854 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
15855 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
15856 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
15857 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
15858 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
15859 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
15860 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
15861 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
15862 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
15863 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
15864 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
15865 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
15866
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020015867meth(<method>) : method
15868 Returns a method.
15869
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010015870nbproc : integer
15871 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
15872 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
15873 and debugging purposes.
15874
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015875nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
15876 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
15877 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
15878 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015879 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
15880 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
15881 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010015882
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040015883prio_class : integer
15884 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
15885 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
15886 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
15887
15888prio_offset : integer
15889 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
15890 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
15891 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
15892 set-priority-offset".
15893
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010015894proc : integer
15895 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
15896 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
15897 debugging purposes.
15898
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015899queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015900 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
15901 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
15902 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015903 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
15904 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
15905 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
15906 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
15907 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
15908
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010015909rand([<range>]) : integer
15910 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
15911 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
15912 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
15913 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
15914 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
15915
Luca Schimweg8a694b82019-09-10 15:42:52 +020015916uuid([<version>]) : string
15917 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
15918 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
15919 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
15920
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015921srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
15922 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
15923 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
15924 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
15925 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
15926 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040015927 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
15928 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
15929
15930srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
15931 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
15932 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
15933 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
15934 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
15935 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
15936 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
15937 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
15938
15939 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
15940 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015941
15942srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
15943 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
15944 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
15945 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015946 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015947 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
15948 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
15949 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
15950
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020015951srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
15952 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
15953 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
15954 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
15955 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
15956 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
15957 fetch methods.
15958
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015959srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
15960 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
15961 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015962 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015963 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
15964 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015965 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015966 overloading servers).
15967
15968 Example :
15969 # Redirect to a separate back
15970 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
15971 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
15972 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
15973
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010015974stopping : boolean
15975 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
15976 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
15977 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
15978
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020015979str(<string>) : string
15980 Returns a string.
15981
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015982table_avl([<table>]) : integer
15983 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
15984 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
15985
15986table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15987 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
15988 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
15989 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
15990
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010015991thread : integer
15992 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
15993 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
15994 and debugging purposes.
15995
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015996var(<var-name>) : undefined
15997 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015998 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
15999 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016000 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016001 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16002 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016003 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016004 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16005 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016006 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016007 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016008
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200160097.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016010----------------------------------
16011
16012The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
16013closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
16014methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
16015sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
16016TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016017the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
16018counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020016019"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
16020used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
16021can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
16022Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
16023table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
16024tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
16025currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016026
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010016027bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010016028 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
16029 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
16030 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
16031
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016032be_id : integer
16033 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020016034 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
16035 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016036
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010016037be_name : string
16038 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020016039 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
16040 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010016041
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016042dst : ip
16043 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
16044 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
16045 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
16046 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010016047 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
16048 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
16049 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
16050 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
16051 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
16052 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016053
16054dst_conn : integer
16055 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
16056 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
16057 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
16058 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
16059 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
16060 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
16061 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
16062 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016063
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020016064dst_is_local : boolean
16065 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
16066 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
16067 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
16068 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016069 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020016070 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
16071 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
16072 it only once per connection.
16073
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016074dst_port : integer
16075 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
16076 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
16077 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
16078 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
16079 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
16080 an HTTP header.
16081
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020016082fc_http_major : integer
16083 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
16084 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
16085 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
16086
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020016087fc_pp_authority : string
16088 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
16089 if any.
16090
Tim Duesterhusd1b15b62020-03-13 12:34:23 +010016091fc_pp_unique_id : string
16092 Returns the unique ID TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
16093 if any.
16094
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010016095fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
16096 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
16097 header.
16098
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020016099fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
16100 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
16101 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
16102 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
16103 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
16104 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
16105 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16106
16107fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
16108 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
16109 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
16110 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
16111 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
16112 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
16113 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16114
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016115fc_unacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016116 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
16117 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
16118 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
16119 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16120
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016121fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016122 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
16123 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
16124 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
16125 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16126
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016127fc_retrans : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016128 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
16129 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
16130 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
16131 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16132
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016133fc_fackets : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016134 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
16135 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
16136 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
16137 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16138
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016139fc_lost : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016140 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
16141 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
16142 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
16143 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16144
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016145fc_reordering : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016146 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
16147 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
16148 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
16149 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16150
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020016151fe_defbe : string
16152 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
16153 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
16154
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016155fe_id : integer
16156 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010016157 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016158 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
16159
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010016160fe_name : string
16161 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
16162 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
16163 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
16164
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016165sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016166sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
16167sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
16168sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016169 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
16170 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
16171 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
16172
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016173sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016174sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
16175sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
16176sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016177 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
16178 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
16179 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
16180
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016181sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016182sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16183sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16184sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016185 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
16186 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010016187 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
16188 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
16189 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016190
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016191 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016192 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
16193 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016194 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
16195 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
16196 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016197 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
16198 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
16199
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016200sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16201sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16202sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16203sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16204 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
16205 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
16206 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
16207 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
16208 when a first ACL was verified.
16209
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016210sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016211sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16212sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16213sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016214 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016215 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
16216
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016217sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016218sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
16219sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
16220sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016221 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
16222 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
16223 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
16224
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016225sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016226sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
16227sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
16228sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016229 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
16230 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
16231 See also src_conn_rate.
16232
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016233sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016234sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16235sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16236sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016237 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016238 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016239
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016240sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16241sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16242sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16243sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16244 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
16245 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
16246
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020016247sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16248sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
16249sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
16250sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
16251 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
16252 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
16253
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016254sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016255sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
16256sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
16257sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016258 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
16259 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
16260 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016261 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
16262 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
16263 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016264
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016265sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16266sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
16267sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
16268sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
16269 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
16270 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
16271 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
16272 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
16273 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
16274 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
16275
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016276sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016277sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16278sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16279sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016280 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016281 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
16282 See also src_http_err_cnt.
16283
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016284sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016285sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
16286sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
16287sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016288 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
16289 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
16290 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
16291 src_http_err_rate.
16292
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016293sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016294sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16295sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16296sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016297 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016298 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
16299 src_http_req_cnt.
16300
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016301sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016302sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
16303sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
16304sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016305 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
16306 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
16307 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
16308 src_http_req_rate.
16309
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016310sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016311sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16312sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16313sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016314 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010016315 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
16316 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
16317 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
16318 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016319
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016320 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016321 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
16322 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016323 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
16324
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016325sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16326sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16327sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16328sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16329 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
16330 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
16331 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
16332 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
16333 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
16334
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016335sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016336sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
16337sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
16338sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020016339 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
16340 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
16341 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016342
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016343sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016344sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
16345sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
16346sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020016347 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
16348 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
16349 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016350
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016351sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016352sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16353sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16354sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016355 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016356 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
16357 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
16358 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016359 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016360 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
16361
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016362sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016363sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
16364sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
16365sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016366 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
16367 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
16368 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
16369 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
16370 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016371 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016372
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016373sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016374sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
16375sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
16376sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020016377 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
16378 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
16379 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
16380
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016381sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016382sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
16383sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
16384sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010016385 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
16386 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016387 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010016388 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
16389 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016390 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
16391 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
16392 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010016393
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016394so_id : integer
16395 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
16396 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
16397 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016398
Jerome Magnineb421b22020-03-27 22:08:40 +010016399so_name : string
16400 Returns a string containing the current listening socket's name, as defined
16401 with name on a "bind" line. It can serve the same purposes as so_id but with
16402 strings instead of integers.
16403
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016404src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016405 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016406 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
16407 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
16408 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016409 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
16410 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
16411 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010016412 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
16413 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
16414 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
16415 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
16416 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
16417 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
16418 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016419
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016420 Example:
16421 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
16422 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
16423
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016424src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
16425 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
16426 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
16427 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016428 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016429
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016430src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
16431 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
16432 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016433 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016434 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016435
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016436src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16437 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
16438 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
16439 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
16440 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
16441 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
16442 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016443
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016444 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016445 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
16446 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
16447 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
16448 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010016449 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016450 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
16451 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
16452
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016453src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16454 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
16455 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
16456 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
16457 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
16458 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
16459 was verified.
16460
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016461src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016462 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016463 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016464 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016465 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016466
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016467src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016468 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016469 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
16470 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016471 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016472
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016473src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
16474 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
16475 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
16476 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016477 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016478
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016479src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016480 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016481 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016482 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016483 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016484
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016485src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16486 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
16487 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
16488 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
16489 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
16490
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020016491src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
16492 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
16493 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
16494 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
16495 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
16496
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016497src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016498 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016499 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016500 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
16501 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016502 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
16503 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
16504 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016505
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016506src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
16507 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
16508 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
16509 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
16510 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
16511 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
16512 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
16513 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
16514
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016515src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016516 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016517 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016518 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016519 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016520 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016521
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016522src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
16523 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
16524 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
16525 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
16526 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016527 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016528
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016529src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016530 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016531 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
16532 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016533 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016534
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016535src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
16536 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
16537 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
16538 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016539 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016540 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016541
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016542src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16543 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
16544 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
16545 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016546 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016547 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
16548 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016549
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016550 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016551 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010016552 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016553 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016554
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016555src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16556 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
16557 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
16558 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
16559 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
16560 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
16561 connection when a first ACL was verified.
16562
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020016563src_is_local : boolean
16564 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
16565 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
16566 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
16567 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016568 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020016569 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
16570 once per connection.
16571
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016572src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020016573 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
16574 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
16575 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
16576 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
16577 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016578
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016579src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020016580 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
16581 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
16582 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
16583 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
16584 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020016585
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016586src_port : integer
16587 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
16588 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
16589 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
16590 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010016591
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016592src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016593 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016594 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
16595 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
16596 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016597 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016598
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016599src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
16600 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
16601 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
16602 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
16603 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016604 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016605
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016606src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16607 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
16608 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
16609 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
16610 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
16611 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
16612 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
16613 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
16614 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020016615
16616 Example :
16617 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
16618 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
16619 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
16620 listen ssh
16621 bind :22
16622 mode tcp
16623 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016624 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016625 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020016626 server local 127.0.0.1:22
16627
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016628srv_id : integer
16629 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
16630 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020016631 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020016632
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080016633srv_name : string
16634 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
16635 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020016636 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080016637
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200166387.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016639----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020016640
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016641The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
16642closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
16643when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
16644usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016645future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020016646
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001664751d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
16648 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
16649 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
16650 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
16651 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
16652 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
16653
16654 Example :
16655 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
16656 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
16657 # the request.
16658 frontend http-in
16659 bind *:8081
16660 default_backend servers
16661 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
16662 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
16663
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016664ssl_bc : boolean
16665 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
16666 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016667 other a server with the "ssl" option. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
16668 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016669
16670ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
16671 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016672 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
16673 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016674
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010016675ssl_bc_alpn : string
16676 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
16677 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020016678 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010016679 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
16680 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
16681 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
16682 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
16683 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016684 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn". It can be used in a
16685 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010016686
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016687ssl_bc_cipher : string
16688 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016689 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
16690 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016691
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040016692ssl_bc_client_random : binary
16693 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
16694 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
16695 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016696 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040016697
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010016698ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
16699 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
16700 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016701 session or a TLS ticket. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
16702 ruleset.
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010016703
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010016704ssl_bc_npn : string
16705 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
16706 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020016707 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010016708 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
16709 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
16710 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
16711 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016712 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN. It can be used in a tcp-check
16713 or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010016714
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016715ssl_bc_protocol : string
16716 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016717 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
16718 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016719
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020016720ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016721 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020016722 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016723 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64". It
16724 can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016725
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040016726ssl_bc_server_random : binary
16727 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
16728 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
16729 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016730 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040016731
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016732ssl_bc_session_id : binary
16733 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
16734 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016735 if session was reused or not. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
16736 ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016737
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040016738ssl_bc_session_key : binary
16739 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
16740 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
16741 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016742 BoringSSL. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040016743
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016744ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
16745 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016746 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
16747 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016748
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016749ssl_c_ca_err : integer
16750 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16751 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
16752 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
16753 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
16754 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020016755
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016756ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
16757 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16758 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
16759 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
16760 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016761
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010016762ssl_c_der : binary
16763 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
16764 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
16765 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
16766
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016767ssl_c_err : integer
16768 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16769 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
16770 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
16771 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
16772 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016773
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016774ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016775 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16776 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
16777 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
16778 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
16779 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
16780 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
16781 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
16782 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016783 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
16784 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
16785 LDAP v3.
16786 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
16787 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016788
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016789ssl_c_key_alg : string
16790 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
16791 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
16792 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016793
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016794ssl_c_notafter : string
16795 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
16796 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
16797 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020016798
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016799ssl_c_notbefore : string
16800 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
16801 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
16802 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010016803
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016804ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016805 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16806 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
16807 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
16808 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
16809 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
16810 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
16811 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
16812 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016813 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
16814 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
16815 LDAP v3.
16816 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
16817 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010016818
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016819ssl_c_serial : binary
16820 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
16821 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
16822 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016823
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016824ssl_c_sha1 : binary
16825 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
16826 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
16827 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020016828 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
16829 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
16830
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016831 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020016832 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016833
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016834ssl_c_sig_alg : string
16835 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
16836 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
16837 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020016838
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016839ssl_c_used : boolean
16840 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
16841 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020016842
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016843ssl_c_verify : integer
16844 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
16845 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
16846 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
16847 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020016848
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016849ssl_c_version : integer
16850 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
16851 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020016852
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010016853ssl_f_der : binary
16854 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
16855 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
16856 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
16857
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016858ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016859 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16860 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
16861 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
16862 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020016863 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016864 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
16865 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
16866 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016867 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
16868 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
16869 LDAP v3.
16870 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
16871 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020016872
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016873ssl_f_key_alg : string
16874 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
16875 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
16876 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020016877
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016878ssl_f_notafter : string
16879 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
16880 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
16881 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016882
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016883ssl_f_notbefore : string
16884 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
16885 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
16886 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020016887
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016888ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016889 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16890 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
16891 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
16892 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
16893 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
16894 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
16895 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
16896 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016897 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
16898 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
16899 LDAP v3.
16900 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
16901 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020016902
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016903ssl_f_serial : binary
16904 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
16905 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
16906 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020016907
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020016908ssl_f_sha1 : binary
16909 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
16910 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
16911 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
16912
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016913ssl_f_sig_alg : string
16914 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
16915 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
16916 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020016917
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016918ssl_f_version : integer
16919 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
16920 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
16921
16922ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016923 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
16924 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
16925 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
16926
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016927 Example :
16928 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
16929 listen http-https
16930 bind :80
16931 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
16932 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
16933
16934ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
16935 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
16936 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
16937
16938ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016939 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016940 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
16941 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
16942 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
16943 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
16944 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
16945 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
16946 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
16947 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
16948
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016949ssl_fc_cipher : string
16950 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
16951 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020016952
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016953ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
16954 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
16955 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010016956 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016957
16958ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
16959 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
16960 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010016961 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016962
16963ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
16964 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
16965 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
16966 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016967 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020016968 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016969
16970ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
16971 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
16972 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010016973 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016974
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040016975ssl_fc_client_random : binary
16976 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
16977 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
16978 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
16979
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016980ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016981 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
16982 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010016983 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
16984 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
16985 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
16986 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016987
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020016988ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
16989 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
16990 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
16991 wait until the handshake happened.
16992
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016993ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
16994 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020016995 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
16996 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016997 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020016998 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020016999
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020017000ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020017001 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010017002 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
17003 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020017004
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017005ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017006 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017007 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
17008 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
17009 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
17010 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
17011 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
17012 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
17013 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020017014
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017015ssl_fc_protocol : string
17016 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
17017 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020017018
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020017019ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040017020 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020017021 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
17022 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040017023
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017024ssl_fc_server_random : binary
17025 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
17026 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
17027 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
17028
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017029ssl_fc_session_id : binary
17030 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
17031 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
17032 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
17033 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020017034
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040017035ssl_fc_session_key : binary
17036 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
17037 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
17038 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
17039 BoringSSL.
17040
17041
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017042ssl_fc_sni : string
17043 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
17044 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
17045 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
17046 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
17047 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
17048
17049 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
17050 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
17051 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017052 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020017053 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017054
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017055 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017056 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
17057 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020017058
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017059ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
17060 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
17061 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020017062
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020017063
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200170647.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017065------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020017066
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017067Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
17068sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
17069only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
17070For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
17071be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
17072can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
17073sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
17074for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
17075content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017076
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017077payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017078 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017079 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
17080 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017081
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017082payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
17083 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017084 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017085 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017086
Thierry FOURNIERd7d88812017-04-19 15:15:14 +020017087req.hdrs : string
17088 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
17089 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
17090 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
17091 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
17092
Thierry FOURNIER5617dce2017-04-09 05:38:19 +020017093req.hdrs_bin : binary
17094 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
17095 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
17096 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
17097 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
17098 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
17099 names and values (length of 0 for both).
17100
17101 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
17102
17103 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
17104 str: <int:length><bytes>
17105
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017106req.len : integer
17107req_len : integer (deprecated)
17108 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
17109 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
17110 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
17111 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
17112 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
17113 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
17114 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
17115 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017116
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017117req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
17118 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020017119 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
17120 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
17121 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
17122 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017123
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017124 ACL alternatives :
17125 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017126
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017127req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
17128 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
17129 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
17130 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
17131 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017132
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017133 ACL alternatives :
17134 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017135
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017136 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017137
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017138req.proto_http : boolean
17139req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
17140 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
17141 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
17142 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
17143 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
17144 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
17145 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
17146 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017147
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017148 Example:
17149 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
17150 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
17151 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017152 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017153
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017154req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
17155rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
17156 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
17157 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
17158 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
17159 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
17160 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
17161 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
17162 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017163
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017164 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
17165 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
17166 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
17167 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
17168 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
17169 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017170
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017171 ACL derivatives :
17172 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017173
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017174 Example :
17175 listen tse-farm
17176 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
17177 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
17178 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
17179 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
17180 # apply RDP cookie persistence
17181 persist rdp-cookie
17182 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
17183 # This is only useful makes sense if
17184 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
17185 stick-table type string size 204800
17186 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
17187 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
17188 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017189
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017190 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
17191 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017192
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017193req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
17194rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
17195 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
17196 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
17197 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
17198 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017199
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017200 ACL derivatives :
17201 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017202
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110017203req.ssl_alpn : string
17204 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
17205 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
17206 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
17207 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
17208 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
17209 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020017210 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110017211
17212 Examples :
17213 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
17214 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
17215 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020017216 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110017217 default_backend bk_default
17218
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020017219req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
17220 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
17221 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020017222 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
17223 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
17224 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
17225 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
17226 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020017227
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017228req.ssl_hello_type : integer
17229req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
17230 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
17231 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
17232 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
17233 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
17234 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
17235 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
17236 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017237
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017238req.ssl_sni : string
17239req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
17240 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
17241 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
17242 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
17243 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
17244 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
17245 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
17246 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
17247 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
17248 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
17249 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
17250 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
17251 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017252
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017253 ACL derivatives :
17254 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017255
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017256 Examples :
17257 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
17258 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
17259 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
17260 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
17261 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017262
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053017263req.ssl_st_ext : integer
17264 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
17265 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
17266 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
17267 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
17268 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
17269 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
17270 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
17271 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
17272 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
17273
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017274req.ssl_ver : integer
17275req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
17276 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
17277 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
17278 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
17279 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
17280 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
17281 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
17282 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017283 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017284 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017285
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017286 ACL derivatives :
17287 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017288
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020017289res.len : integer
17290 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
17291 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
17292 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
17293 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
17294 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
17295 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
17296 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017297 content inspection. But it may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020017298
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017299res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
17300 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020017301 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017302 the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020017303 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017304 any location. It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017305
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017306res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
17307 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
17308 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
17309 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017310 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign. It may also be used in tcp-check based
17311 expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017312
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017313 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017314
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020017315res.ssl_hello_type : integer
17316rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
17317 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
17318 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
17319 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
17320 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
17321 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
17322 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
17323 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
17324
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017325wait_end : boolean
17326 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
17327 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017328 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017329 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
17330 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017331 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017332 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
17333 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017334
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017335 Examples :
17336 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
17337 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
17338 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017339
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017340 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
17341 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
17342 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
17343 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
17344 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
17345 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
17346 tcp-request content reject
17347
17348
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200173497.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017350--------------------------------------
17351
17352It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
17353This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
17354data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
17355its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
17356HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
17357content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
17358to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
17359more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
17360response are indexed.
17361
17362base : string
17363 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
17364 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
17365 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
17366 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
17367 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
17368 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
17369 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
17370 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
17371
17372 ACL derivatives :
17373 base : exact string match
17374 base_beg : prefix match
17375 base_dir : subdir match
17376 base_dom : domain match
17377 base_end : suffix match
17378 base_len : length match
17379 base_reg : regex match
17380 base_sub : substring match
17381
17382base32 : integer
17383 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
17384 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
17385 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017386 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
17387 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
17388 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017389
17390base32+src : binary
17391 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
17392 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
17393 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
17394 per-URL counters.
17395
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010017396capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
17397 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
17398 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
17399 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
17400
17401capture.req.method : string
17402 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
17403 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
17404 because it's allocated.
17405
17406capture.req.uri : string
17407 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
17408 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
17409 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
17410 allocated.
17411
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020017412capture.req.ver : string
17413 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
17414 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
17415 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
17416
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010017417capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
17418 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
17419 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
17420 The first entry is an index of 0.
17421 See also: "capture response header"
17422
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020017423capture.res.ver : string
17424 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
17425 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
17426 persistent flag.
17427
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020017428req.body : binary
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020017429 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It is
17430 recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as much
17431 as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020017432
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020017433req.body_param([<name>) : string
17434 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
17435 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
17436 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
17437 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
17438 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
17439 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
17440 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
17441 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
17442 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
17443 given.
17444
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020017445req.body_len : integer
17446 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
17447 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020017448 is recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as
17449 much as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020017450
17451req.body_size : integer
17452 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020017453 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
17454 available data in case of chunked encoding.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020017455
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017456req.cook([<name>]) : string
17457cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
17458 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
17459 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
17460 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
17461 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
17462 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
17463 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
17464 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
17465 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
17466
17467 ACL derivatives :
17468 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
17469 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
17470 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
17471 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
17472 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
17473 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
17474 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
17475 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017476
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017477req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
17478cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
17479 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
17480 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017481
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017482req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
17483cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
17484 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
17485 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
17486 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
17487 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020017488
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017489cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
17490 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
17491 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
17492 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
17493 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020017494 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017495 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
17496 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
17497 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
17498 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017499
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017500hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
17501 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
17502 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
17503 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
17504 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017505 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017506
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017507req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
17508 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
17509 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
17510 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
17511 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
17512 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
17513 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
17514 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
17515 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017516
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017517req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
17518 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
17519 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
17520 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
17521 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017522
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017523req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
17524 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
17525 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
17526 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
17527 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
17528 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
17529 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
17530 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
17531 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +000017532 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC7231 to know
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017533 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017534 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017535
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017536 ACL derivatives :
17537 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
17538 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
17539 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
17540 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
17541 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
17542 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
17543 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
17544 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
17545
17546req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
17547hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
17548 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
17549 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
17550 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
17551 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
17552 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
17553 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
17554 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
17555 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
17556 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
17557
17558req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
17559hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
17560 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
17561 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
17562 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
17563 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
17564 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017565 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017566 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
17567 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
17568
17569req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
17570hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
17571 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
17572 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
17573 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
17574 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
17575 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
17576 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
17577 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
17578
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010017579
17580
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017581http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
17582 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
17583 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
17584 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
17585 basic auth is supported.
17586
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010017587http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
17588 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
17589 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
17590 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
17591 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017592 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
17593 basic auth is supported.
17594
17595 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010017596 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
17597 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
17598 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
17599 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017600
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020017601http_auth_pass : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010017602 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
17603 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
17604 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020017605
17606http_auth_type : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010017607 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
17608 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
17609 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020017610
17611http_auth_user : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010017612 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
17613 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
17614 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020017615
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017616http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020017617 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
17618 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017619 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
17620 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020017621
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017622method : integer + string
17623 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
17624 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
17625 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
17626 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
17627 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
17628 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
17629 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017630
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017631 ACL derivatives :
17632 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017633
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017634 Example :
17635 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
17636 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
17637 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017638
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017639path : string
17640 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
17641 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
17642 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
17643 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
17644 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017645 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017646 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017647
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017648 ACL derivatives :
17649 path : exact string match
17650 path_beg : prefix match
17651 path_dir : subdir match
17652 path_dom : domain match
17653 path_end : suffix match
17654 path_len : length match
17655 path_reg : regex match
17656 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017657
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010017658query : string
17659 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
17660 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
17661 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
17662 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010017663 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010017664 which stops before the question mark.
17665
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010017666req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
17667 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
17668 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
17669 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
17670 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
17671
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017672req.ver : string
17673req_ver : string (deprecated)
17674 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
17675 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
17676 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017677
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017678 ACL derivatives :
17679 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020017680
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017681res.body : binary
17682 This returns the HTTP response's available body as a block of data. Unlike
17683 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
17684 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context. It
17685 may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
17686
17687res.body_len : integer
17688 This returns the length of the HTTP response available body in bytes. Unlike
17689 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
17690 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context. It
17691 may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
17692
17693res.body_size : integer
17694 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP response body in bytes. It
17695 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
17696 available data in case of chunked encoding. Unlike the request side, there is
17697 no directive to wait for the response body. This sample fetch is really
17698 useful (and usable) in the health-check context. It may be used in tcp-check
17699 based expect rules.
17700
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017701res.comp : boolean
17702 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
17703 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
17704 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017705
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017706res.comp_algo : string
17707 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
17708 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
17709 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017710
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017711res.cook([<name>]) : string
17712scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
17713 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
17714 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017715 specified, the first cookie value is returned. It may be used in tcp-check
17716 based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020017717
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017718 ACL derivatives :
17719 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020017720
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017721res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
17722scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
17723 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
17724 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017725 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses. It may
17726 be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017727
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017728res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
17729scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
17730 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
17731 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017732 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. It may
17733 be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017734
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017735res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
17736 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
17737 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
17738 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
17739 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
17740 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
17741 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
17742 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
17743 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017744 Expires. It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017745
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017746res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
17747 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
17748 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
17749 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
17750 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017751 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead. It may be used in
17752 tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017753
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017754res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
17755shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
17756 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
17757 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
17758 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
17759 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
17760 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
17761 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
17762 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017763 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead. It may be used in tcp-check based
17764 expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017765
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017766 ACL derivatives :
17767 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
17768 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
17769 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
17770 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
17771 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
17772 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
17773 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
17774 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
17775
17776res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
17777shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
17778 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
17779 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
17780 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
17781 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017782 instead. It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017783
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017784res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
17785shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
17786 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
17787 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
17788 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
17789 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
17790 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017791 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table. It
17792 may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017793
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010017794res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
17795 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
17796 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
17797 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017798 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered. It may be used
17799 in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010017800
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017801res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
17802shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
17803 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
17804 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
17805 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
17806 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
17807 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017808 useful to learn some data into a stick table. It may be used in tcp-check
17809 based expect rules.
17810
17811res.hdrs : string
17812 Returns the current response headers as string including the last empty line
17813 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
17814 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
17815 headers analyzers and for advanced logging. It may also be used in tcp-check
17816 based expect rules.
17817
17818res.hdrs_bin : binary
17819 Returns the current response headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
17820 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. It may be used in
17821 tcp-check based expect rules. Each string is described by a length followed
17822 by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The length is represented
17823 using the variable integer encoding detailed in the SPOE documentation. The
17824 end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header names and values
17825 (length of 0 for both).
17826
17827 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
17828
17829 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
17830 str: <int:length><bytes>
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010017831
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017832res.ver : string
17833resp_ver : string (deprecated)
17834 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017835 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. It may be used in
17836 tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020017837
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017838 ACL derivatives :
17839 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010017840
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017841set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
17842 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
17843 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020017844 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017845 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010017846
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017847 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
17848 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010017849
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017850status : integer
17851 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
17852 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017853 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx. It may be used in
17854 tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017855
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020017856unique-id : string
17857 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
17858 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
17859 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
17860 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
17861 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
17862 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
17863
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017864url : string
17865 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
17866 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
17867 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
17868 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
17869 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
17870 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
17871 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017872
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017873 ACL derivatives :
17874 url : exact string match
17875 url_beg : prefix match
17876 url_dir : subdir match
17877 url_dom : domain match
17878 url_end : suffix match
17879 url_len : length match
17880 url_reg : regex match
17881 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017882
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017883url_ip : ip
17884 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
17885 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
17886 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
17887 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
17888 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
17889 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
17890 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017891
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017892url_port : integer
17893 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
17894 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
17895 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
17896 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017897
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020017898urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
17899url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017900 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
17901 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020017902 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
17903 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
17904 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
17905 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017906 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
17907 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020017908 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
17909 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017910
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017911 ACL derivatives :
17912 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
17913 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
17914 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
17915 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
17916 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
17917 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
17918 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
17919 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017920
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017921
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017922 Example :
17923 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
17924 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
17925 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
17926 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017927
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017928urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017929 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
17930 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
17931 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020017932
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020017933url32 : integer
17934 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
17935 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
17936 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
17937 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
17938 is an unsigned integer.
17939
17940url32+src : binary
17941 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
17942 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
17943 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
17944
Christopher Faulet16032ab2020-04-30 11:30:00 +020017945
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200179467.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010017947---------------------------------------
17948
17949This set of sample fetch methods is reserved to developers and must never be
17950used on a production environment, except on developer demand, for debugging
17951purposes. Moreover, no special care will be taken on backwards compatibility.
17952There is no warranty the following sample fetches will never change, be renamed
17953or simply removed. So be really careful if you should use one of them. To avoid
17954any ambiguity, these sample fetches are placed in the dedicated scope "internal",
17955for instance "internal.strm.is_htx".
17956
17957internal.htx.data : integer
17958 Returns the size in bytes used by data in the HTX message associated to a
17959 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
17960
17961internal.htx.free : integer
17962 Returns the free space (size - used) in bytes in the HTX message associated
17963 to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
17964
17965internal.htx.free_data : integer
17966 Returns the free space for the data in bytes in the HTX message associated to
17967 a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
17968
17969internal.htx.has_eom : boolean
17970 Returns true if the HTX message associated to a channel contains an
17971 end-of-message block (EOM). Otherwise, it returns false. The channel is
17972 chosen depending on the sample direction.
17973
17974internal.htx.nbblks : integer
17975 Returns the number of blocks present in the HTX message associated to a
17976 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
17977
17978internal.htx.size : integer
17979 Returns the total size in bytes of the HTX message associated to a
17980 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
17981
17982internal.htx.used : integer
17983 Returns the total size used in bytes (data + metadata) in the HTX message
17984 associated to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
17985 direction.
17986
17987internal.htx_blk.size(<idx>) : integer
17988 Returns the size of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
17989 associated to a channel or 0 if it does not exist. The channel is chosen
17990 depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one
17991 of the special value :
17992 * head : The oldest inserted block
17993 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050017994 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010017995
17996internal.htx_blk.type(<idx>) : string
17997 Returns the type of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
17998 associated to a channel or "HTX_BLK_UNUSED" if it does not exist. The channel
17999 is chosen depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive
18000 integer or one of the special value :
18001 * head : The oldest inserted block
18002 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018003 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018004
18005internal.htx_blk.data(<idx>) : binary
18006 Returns the value of the DATA block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
18007 associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if it is
18008 not a DATA block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18009 <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
18010
18011 * head : The oldest inserted block
18012 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018013 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018014
18015internal.htx_blk.hdrname(<idx>) : string
18016 Returns the header name of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
18017 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
18018 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
18019 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
18020
18021 * head : The oldest inserted block
18022 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018023 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018024
18025internal.htx_blk.hdrval(<idx>) : string
18026 Returns the header value of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
18027 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
18028 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
18029 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
18030
18031 * head : The oldest inserted block
18032 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018033 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018034
18035internal.htx_blk.start_line(<idx>) : string
18036 Returns the value of the REQ_SL or RES_SL block at the position <idx> in the
18037 HTX message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist
18038 or if it is not a SL block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
18039 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
18040
18041 * head : The oldest inserted block
18042 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018043 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018044
18045internal.strm.is_htx : boolean
18046 Returns true if the current stream is an HTX stream. It means the data in the
18047 channels buffers are stored using the internal HTX representation. Otherwise,
18048 it returns false.
18049
18050
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200180517.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018052---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010018053
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018054Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
18055every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020018056order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010018057
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018058ACL name Equivalent to Usage
18059---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018060FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020018061HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018062HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
18063HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018064HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
18065HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
18066HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
18067HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
18068LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018069METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020018070METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018071METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
18072METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
18073METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
18074METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020018075METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018076METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020018077RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018078REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018079TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018080WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
18081---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010018082
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010018083
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200180848. Logging
18085----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010018086
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018087One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
18088provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
18089very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
18090provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
18091state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018092to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018093headers.
18094
18095In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
18096about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
18097send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
18098
18099 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
18100 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
18101 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
18102 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
18103 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018104 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060018105 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018106
18107The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
18108allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
18109as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
18110while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
18111real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
18112delay.
18113
18114
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200181158.1. Log levels
18116---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018117
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090018118TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018119source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090018120HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
18121in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
18122track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
18123syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
18124about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018125
18126
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200181278.2. Log formats
18128----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018129
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018130HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090018131and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
18132slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
18133options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018134
18135 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
18136 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
18137 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
18138 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
18139 extents.
18140
18141 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
18142 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
18143 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
18144 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
18145 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
18146
18147 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
18148 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
18149 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
18150 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
18151 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
18152
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020018153 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
18154 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
18155 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
18156 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
18157
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018158 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
18159
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018160Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
18161specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
18162field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
18163servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
18164always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
18165identifier.
18166
18167Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
18168 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
18169 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
18170 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
18171 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
18172
18173
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200181748.2.1. Default log format
18175-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018176
18177This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
18178as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
18179format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
18180
18181 Example :
18182 listen www
18183 mode http
18184 log global
18185 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
18186
18187 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
18188 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
18189 (www/HTTP)
18190
18191 Field Format Extract from the example above
18192 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
18193 2 'Connect from' Connect from
18194 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
18195 4 'to' to
18196 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
18197 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
18198
18199Detailed fields description :
18200 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
18201 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
18202 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
18203 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
18204 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
18205 and processed the connection.
18206 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
18207
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010018208In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
18209"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
18210connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
18211
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018212It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
18213will eventually disappear.
18214
18215
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200182168.2.2. TCP log format
18217---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018218
18219The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
18220is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
18221information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
18222counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
18223emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
18224environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
18225the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
18226sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020018227specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
18228not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
18229fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
18230marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018231
18232 Example :
18233 frontend fnt
18234 mode tcp
18235 option tcplog
18236 log global
18237 default_backend bck
18238
18239 backend bck
18240 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
18241
18242 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
18243 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
18244 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
18245
18246 Field Format Extract from the example above
18247 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
18248 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
18249 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
18250 4 frontend_name fnt
18251 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
18252 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
18253 7 bytes_read* 212
18254 8 termination_state --
18255 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
18256 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
18257
18258Detailed fields description :
18259 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010018260 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
18261 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
18262 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010018263 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018264 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010018265 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018266
18267 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010018268 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
18269 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
18270 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018271
18272 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
18273 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
18274 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018275 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
18276 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
18277 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
18278 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018279
18280 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
18281 and processed the connection.
18282
18283 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
18284 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
18285 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
18286 applications.
18287
18288 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
18289 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
18290 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
18291 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
18292 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
18293
18294 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
18295 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
18296 See "Timers" below for more details.
18297
18298 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
18299 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
18300 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
18301 "Timers" below for more details.
18302
18303 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018304 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018305 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
18306 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
18307 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
18308 details.
18309
18310 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
18311 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
18312 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
18313 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
18314 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
18315
18316 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
18317 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
18318 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
18319 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
18320 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
18321 for more details.
18322
18323 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018324 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018325 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
18326 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
18327 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018328 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018329
18330 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
18331 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
18332 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
18333 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
18334 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
18335 caused by a denial of service attack.
18336
18337 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
18338 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
18339 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
18340 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
18341 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
18342 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
18343 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
18344 denial of service attack.
18345
18346 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
18347 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
18348 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
18349 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
18350 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
18351 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
18352 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
18353 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
18354 be processed than on other servers.
18355
18356 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
18357 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
18358 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
18359 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
18360 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
18361 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
18362 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
18363 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
18364 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
18365 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
18366 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
18367 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
18368 should not be attributed to the logged server.
18369
18370 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
18371 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
18372 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
18373 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
18374 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
18375 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018376 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018377 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
18378
18379 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
18380 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
18381 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
18382 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
18383 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
18384 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018385 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018386 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
18387 occurs.
18388
18389
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200183908.2.3. HTTP log format
18391----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018392
18393The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
18394is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
18395the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
18396are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
18397emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
18398generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
18399"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
18400which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020018401frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
18402is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018403
18404Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
18405slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
18406with a star ('*') after the field name below.
18407
18408 Example :
18409 frontend http-in
18410 mode http
18411 option httplog
18412 log global
18413 default_backend bck
18414
18415 backend static
18416 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
18417
18418 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
18419 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
18420 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018421 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018422
18423 Field Format Extract from the example above
18424 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
18425 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018426 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018427 4 frontend_name http-in
18428 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018429 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018430 7 status_code 200
18431 8 bytes_read* 2750
18432 9 captured_request_cookie -
18433 10 captured_response_cookie -
18434 11 termination_state ----
18435 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
18436 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
18437 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
18438 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
18439 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018440
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018441Detailed fields description :
18442 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010018443 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
18444 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
18445 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010018446 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018447 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010018448 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018449
18450 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010018451 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
18452 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
18453 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018454
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018455 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
18456 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018457
18458 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
18459 and processed the connection.
18460
18461 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
18462 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
18463 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
18464
18465 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
18466 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
18467 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
18468 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
18469 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
18470 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
18471
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018472 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
18473 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
18474 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018475 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018476 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
18477 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018478 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
18479 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018480
18481 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
18482 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018483 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018484
18485 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
18486 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018487 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
18488 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018489
18490 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
18491 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
18492 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
18493 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
18494 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018495 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
18496 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018497
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018498 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
18499 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
18500 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
18501 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
18502 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
18503 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
18504 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018505 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018506
18507 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
18508 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
18509 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
18510
18511 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
18512 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018513 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018514 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
18515 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
18516 overflowing.
18517
18518 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
18519 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
18520 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
18521 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
18522 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
18523 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
18524 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
18525 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
18526
18527 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
18528 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
18529 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
18530 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
18531 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
18532 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
18533 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
18534 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
18535
18536 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
18537 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
18538 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
18539 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
18540 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
18541 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
18542 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
18543
18544 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018545 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018546 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
18547 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
18548 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018549 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018550 system.
18551
18552 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
18553 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
18554 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
18555 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
18556 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
18557 caused by a denial of service attack.
18558
18559 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
18560 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
18561 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
18562 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
18563 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
18564 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
18565 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
18566 denial of service attack.
18567
18568 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
18569 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
18570 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
18571 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
18572 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
18573 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
18574 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
18575 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
18576 processed than on other servers.
18577
18578 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
18579 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
18580 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
18581 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
18582 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
18583 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
18584 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
18585 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
18586 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
18587 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
18588 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
18589 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
18590 should not be attributed to the logged server.
18591
18592 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
18593 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
18594 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
18595 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
18596 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
18597 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018598 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018599 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
18600
18601 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
18602 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
18603 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
18604 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
18605 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
18606 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018607 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018608 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
18609 occurs.
18610
18611 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
18612 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
18613 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
18614 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
18615 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
18616 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
18617 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
18618 cookies" below for more details.
18619
18620 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
18621 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
18622 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
18623 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
18624 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
18625 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
18626 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
18627 and cookies" below for more details.
18628
18629 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
18630 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
18631 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
18632 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
18633 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
18634 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
18635 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
18636 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
18637
18638
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200186398.2.4. Custom log format
18640------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018641
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018642The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018643mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018644
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018645HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018646Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
18647separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
18648prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
18649
18650Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
18651variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010018652("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018653
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010018654If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020018655as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010018656less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
18657the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
18658
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018659Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018660In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010018661in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018662
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010018663Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
18664'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
18665https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
18666such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
18667
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018668Flags are :
18669 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018670 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010018671 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
18672 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018673
18674 Example:
18675
18676 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
18677 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
18678
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010018679 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
18680
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018681At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
18682
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018683 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
18684 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018685
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018686the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018687
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018688 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
18689 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
18690 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018691
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018692and the default TCP format is defined this way :
18693
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018694 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
18695 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018696
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018697Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
18698
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018699 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020018700 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018701 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
18702 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
18703 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018704 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
18705 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
18706 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020018707 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000018708 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
18709 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000018710 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000018711 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
18712 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010018713 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020018714 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020018715 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018716 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018717 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020018718 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080018719 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018720 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
18721 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
18722 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
18723 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
18724 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020018725 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018726 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000018727 | | %Tu | Tu | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018728 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018729 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018730 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
18731 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018732 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
18733 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
18734 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018735 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018736 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
18737 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018738 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018739 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
18740 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
18741 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020018742 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020018743 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020018744 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
18745 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
18746 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
18747 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020018748 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020018749 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020018750 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018751 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010018752 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018753 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018754 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
18755 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
18756 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018757 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020018758 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
18759 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018760 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018761 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
18762 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020018763 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018764 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020018765 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018766 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018767
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020018768 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018769
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010018770
187718.2.5. Error log format
18772-----------------------
18773
18774When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
18775protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
18776By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
18777"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018778will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010018779logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
18780
18781The format looks like this :
18782
18783 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
18784 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
18785 Connection error during SSL handshake
18786
18787 Field Format Extract from the example above
18788 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
18789 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
18790 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
18791 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
18792 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
18793
18794These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
18795failures.
18796
18797
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200187988.3. Advanced logging options
18799-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018800
18801Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
18802just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
18803options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
18804for more information about their usage.
18805
18806
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200188078.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
18808------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018809
18810It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
18811haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
18812commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
18813monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
18814ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
18815
18816 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
18817 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
18818 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
18819 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
18820
18821 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
18822 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
18823 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018824 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018825 such as other load-balancers.
18826
18827 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
18828 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
18829 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
18830
18831
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200188328.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
18833----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018834
18835The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
18836what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
18837or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018838"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018839just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
18840log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
18841after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
18842is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
18843with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
18844with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
18845
18846
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200188478.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
18848------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020018849
18850Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
18851for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
18852"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
18853retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
18854raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
18855a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
18856file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
18857you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
18858"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
18859
18860
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200188618.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
18862--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020018863
18864Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
18865multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
18866them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
18867"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
18868logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
18869error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
18870and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
18871too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
18872useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
18873alternative.
18874
18875
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200188768.4. Timing events
18877------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018878
18879Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
18880reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
18881the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
18882frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018883mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
18884addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
18885
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010018886Timings events in HTTP mode:
18887
18888 first request 2nd request
18889 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
18890 t tr t tr ...
18891 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
18892 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
18893 :<---- Tq ---->: :
18894 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000018895 :<-- -----Tu--------------->:
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010018896 :<--------- Ta --------->:
18897
18898Timings events in TCP mode:
18899
18900 TCP session
18901 |<----------------->|
18902 t t
18903 ---|----|----|----|----|---
18904 | Th Tw Tc Td |
18905 |<------ Tt ------->|
18906
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018907 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018908 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018909 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
18910 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
18911 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018912 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018913 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
18914 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
18915 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
18916 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018917
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018918 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
18919 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
18920 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018921 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
18922 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
18923 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
18924 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
18925 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
18926 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018927
18928 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
18929 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
18930 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
18931 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
18932 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
18933 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
18934 request typed by hand during a test.
18935
18936 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
18937 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018938 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018939 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
18940 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
18941 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
18942 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018943
18944 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
18945 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
18946 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
18947 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
18948 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
18949
18950 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
18951 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
18952 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
18953 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
18954 connection never established.
18955
18956 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
18957 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
18958 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
18959 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
18960 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
18961 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
18962 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
18963 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
18964 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
18965 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
18966 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
18967
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018968 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
18969 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
18970 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
18971 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
18972 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
18973 by subtracting other timers when valid :
18974
18975 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
18976
18977 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
18978 "Ta" can never be negative.
18979
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018980 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
18981 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018982 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
18983 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018984 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018985
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018986 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018987
18988 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018989 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
18990 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018991
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000018992 - Tu: total estimated time as seen from client, between the moment the proxy
18993 accepted it and the moment both ends were closed, without idle time.
18994 This is useful to roughly measure end-to-end time as a user would see it,
18995 without idle time pollution from keep-alive time between requests. This
18996 timer in only an estimation of time seen by user as it assumes network
18997 latency is the same in both directions. The exception is when the "logasap"
18998 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
18999 prefixed with a '+' sign.
19000
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019001These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
19002protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
19003that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019004due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
19005"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
19006that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019007
19008Most common cases :
19009
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019010 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
19011 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
19012 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
19013 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
19014 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
19015 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
19016 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
19017 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
19018 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
19019 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
19020 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020019021 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019022
19023 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
19024 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
19025 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
19026 of ms on remote networks.
19027
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020019028 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
19029 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
19030 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019031
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019032 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
19033 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
19034 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
19035 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
19036 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
19037 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
19038 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
19039 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
19040 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019041
19042Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
19043
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019044 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019045 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019046 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019047
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019048 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019049 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
19050 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
19051
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019052 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019053 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
19054 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
19055 flags.
19056
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019057 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
19058 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019059 Check the session termination flags, then check the
19060 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
19061 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
19062 the client connection was maintained open.
19063
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019064 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019065 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019066 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019067 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
19068
19069
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200190708.5. Session state at disconnection
19071-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019072
19073TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
19074"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
190752-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
19076each of which has a special meaning :
19077
19078 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
19079 session to terminate :
19080
19081 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
19082
19083 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
19084 server explicitly refused it.
19085
19086 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
19087 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
19088 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
19089 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019090 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020019091
19092 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
19093 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019094
19095 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
19096 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
19097 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
19098 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
19099 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
19100
19101 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
19102 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
19103 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
19104 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
19105 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
19106
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090019107 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
19108 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
19109
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070019110 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
19111 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
19112 backup connections when going up.
19113
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020019114 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
19115
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019116 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
19117 send or receive data.
19118
19119 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
19120 send or receive data.
19121
19122 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
19123 with nothing left in the buffers.
19124
19125 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
19126
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010019127 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019128 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
19129
19130 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
19131 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
19132 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
19133 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
19134 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
19135
19136 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
19137 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
19138
19139 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
19140 server (HTTP only).
19141
19142 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
19143
19144 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
19145 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
19146 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
19147
19148 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
19149 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
19150 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
19151
19152 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
19153
19154 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
19155 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
19156
19157 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
19158 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
19159 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
19160
19161 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
19162 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020019163 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
19164 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019165
19166 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
19167 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
19168 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
19169 another server.
19170
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019171 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019172 server.
19173
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019174 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
19175 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
19176 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
19177 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
19178
19179 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
19180 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
19181 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
19182 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
19183
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020019184 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
19185 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
19186 "use-server" rule).
19187
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019188 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
19189
19190 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
19191 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
19192
19193 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
19194
19195 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
19196 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
19197 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
19198
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019199 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
19200 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019201 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019202 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
19203 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
19204
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019205 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
19206
19207 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
19208 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
19209
19210 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
19211
19212 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
19213
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019214The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
19215was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019216helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
19217starvation, attacks, etc...
19218
19219The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
19220alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
19221easier finding and understanding.
19222
19223 Flags Reason
19224
19225 -- Normal termination.
19226
19227 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
19228 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
19229 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
19230 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
19231
19232 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
19233 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
19234 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
19235 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
19236 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
19237 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019238
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019239 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
19240 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020019241 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019242
19243 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
19244 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
19245 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
19246
19247 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
19248 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
19249 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
19250 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
19251 the server takes too long to respond.
19252
19253 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
19254 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
19255 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
19256 long a time to respond.
19257
19258 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
19259 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
19260 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
19261 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020019262 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
19263 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019264
19265 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
19266 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
19267 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
19268 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
19269 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020019270 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020019271 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
19272 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
19273 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
19274 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
19275 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
19276 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
19277 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
19278 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019279 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020019280 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
19281 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
19282 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019283
19284 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
19285 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020019286 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
19287 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
19288 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
19289 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019290
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020019291 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
19292 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
19293
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010019294 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019295 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
19296 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019297 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019298 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
19299 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
19300
19301 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
19302 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
19303 503 or 504 here.
19304
19305 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
19306 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
19307 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
19308 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
19309 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
19310
19311 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
19312 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019313 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019314 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
19315 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
19316
19317 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
19318 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
19319 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
19320 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
19321 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
19322 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
19323 between haproxy and the server.
19324
19325 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
19326 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
19327 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
19328 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
19329 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
19330 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
19331 solution is to fix the application.
19332
19333 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
19334 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
19335 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
19336 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
19337 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
19338 external attacks.
19339
19340 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
19341 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020019342 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019343 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
19344 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
19345
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010019346 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
19347 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
19348 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019349 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020019350 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010019351
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019352 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
19353 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
19354 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
19355 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010019356 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
19357 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
19358 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
19359 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
19360 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019361
19362 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
19363 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
19364 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
19365 returned an HTTP 403 error.
19366
19367 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
19368 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
19369 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
19370 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
19371
19372 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
19373 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
19374 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
19375 only be solved by proper system tuning.
19376
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019377The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
19378persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
19379important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
19380re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
19381
19382 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
19383
19384 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
19385 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
19386 set on a GET request.
19387
19388 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
19389 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040019390 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019391 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
19392
19393 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
19394 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
19395 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
19396
19397 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
19398 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
19399 already got a cookie.
19400
19401 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
19402 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
19403 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
19404 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
19405 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
19406
19407 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
19408 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
19409 new cookie was inserted in the response.
19410
19411 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
19412 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
19413 new cookie was inserted in the response.
19414
19415 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
19416 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
19417
19418 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
19419 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
19420 then advertised in the response.
19421
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019422
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200194238.6. Non-printable characters
19424-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019425
19426In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
19427consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
19428converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
19429prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
19430being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
19431escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
19432is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
19433'}' when logging headers.
19434
19435Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
19436issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
19437containing spaces is "User-Agent".
19438
19439Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
19440the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
19441performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
19442
19443
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200194448.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
19445---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019446
19447Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
19448achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019449section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019450cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
19451the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
19452the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019453locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019454not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
19455user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
19456a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
19457wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
19458
19459 Examples :
19460 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
19461 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
19462
19463 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
19464 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
19465
19466
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200194678.8. Capturing HTTP headers
19468---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019469
19470Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
19471proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
19472the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
19473server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
19474
19475Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
19476response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019477section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019478
19479It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010019480time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
19481appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019482are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
19483and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
19484follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
19485request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
19486in the logs.
19487
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020019488As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
19489frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
19490an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
19491
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019492 Example :
19493 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
19494 listen proxy-out
19495 mode http
19496 option httplog
19497 option logasap
19498 log global
19499 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
19500
19501 # log the name of the virtual server
19502 capture request header Host len 20
19503
19504 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
19505 capture request header Content-Length len 10
19506
19507 # log the beginning of the referrer
19508 capture request header Referer len 20
19509
19510 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
19511 capture response header Server len 20
19512
19513 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
19514 capture response header Content-Length len 10
19515
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019516 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019517 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
19518
19519 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
19520 capture response header Via len 20
19521
19522 # log the URL location during a redirection
19523 capture response header Location len 20
19524
19525 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
19526 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
19527 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
19528 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
19529 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
19530
19531 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
19532 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
19533 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
19534 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019535 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019536
19537 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
19538 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
19539 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
19540 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
19541 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019542 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019543
19544
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200195458.9. Examples of logs
19546---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019547
19548These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
19549them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
19550reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
19551
19552 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
19553 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
19554 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
19555
19556 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
19557 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
19558
19559 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
19560 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
19561 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
19562
19563 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
19564 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
19565
19566 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
19567 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
19568 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
19569
19570 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010019571 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019572 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
19573 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
19574
19575 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
19576 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
19577 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
19578
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020019579 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
19580 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
19581 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
19582 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
19583 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided to
19584 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019585
19586 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019587 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019588
19589 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
19590 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
19591 Nothing was sent to any server.
19592
19593 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
19594 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
19595
19596 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
19597 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019598 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019599 send a 408 return code to the client.
19600
19601 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
19602 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
19603
19604 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
19605 5 seconds ("c----").
19606
19607 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
19608 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019609 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019610
19611 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019612 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019613 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
19614 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
19615 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
19616 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
19617 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010019618
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020019619
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200196209. Supported filters
19621--------------------
19622
19623Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
19624accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
19625unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
19626
19627See also : "filter"
19628
196299.1. Trace
19630----------
19631
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010019632filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020019633
19634 Arguments:
19635 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
19636 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
19637
19638 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
19639 the client and the server. By default, this filter
19640 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
19641 only parses a random amount of the available data.
19642
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019643 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020019644 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
19645 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
19646 amount of the parsed data.
19647
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019648 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010019649
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020019650This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
19651callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
19652information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
19653filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
19654
19655Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
19656tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
19657a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
19658
19659
196609.2. HTTP compression
19661---------------------
19662
19663filter compression
19664
19665The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
19666keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019667when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
19668fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
19669done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
19670explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
19671filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
19672listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
19673order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020019674
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019675See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
19676 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020019677
19678
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200196799.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
19680--------------------------------------------
19681
19682filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
19683
19684 Arguments :
19685
19686 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
19687 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
19688 parsed.
19689
19690 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
19691 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
19692 part must be placed in its own scope.
19693
19694The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
19695external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019696streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020019697exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
19698also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
19699
19700SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
19701the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
19702
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010019703For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020019704"doc/SPOE.txt".
19705
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100197069.4. Cache
19707----------
19708
19709filter cache <name>
19710
19711 Arguments :
19712
19713 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
19714
19715The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
19716"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050019717cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019718other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
19719case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
19720is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
19721filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010019722listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
19723order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010019724
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019725See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
19726 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
19727
19728
197299.5. Fcgi-app
19730-------------
19731
19732filter fcg-app <name>
19733
19734 Arguments :
19735
19736 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
19737
19738The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
19739request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
19740reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
19741used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
19742implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
19743used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
19744fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
19745used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
19746order.
19747
19748See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
19749 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
19750
19751
1975210. FastCGI applications
19753-------------------------
19754
19755HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
19756feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
19757the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
19758FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
19759servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
19760FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
19761backend.
19762
19763HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
19764application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
19765connection.
19766
1976710.1. Setup
19768-----------
19769
1977010.1.1. Fcgi-app section
19771--------------------------
19772
19773fcgi-app <name>
19774 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
19775 document root must be defined.
19776
19777acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
19778 Declare or complete an access list.
19779
19780 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
19781 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
19782 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
19783 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
19784 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
19785
19786docroot <path>
19787 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
19788 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
19789 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
19790
19791index <script-name>
19792 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
19793 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
19794 is an optional setting.
19795
19796 Example :
19797 index index.php
19798
19799log-stderr global
19800log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
19801 [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
19802 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
19803
19804 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
19805 default STDERR messages are ignored.
19806
19807pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
19808 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
19809 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
19810 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
19811
19812 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
19813 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
19814 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
19815 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
19816
19817 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
19818 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
19819
19820path-info <regex>
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010019821 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info from
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010019822 the URL-decoded path. Thus, <regex> may have two captures: the first one to
19823 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. The
19824 first one is mandatory, the second one is optional. This way, it is possible
19825 to extract the script-name from the path ignoring the path-info. It is an
19826 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
19827 path. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not
19828 filled.
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010019829
19830 For security reason, when this regular expression is defined, the newline and
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019831 the null characters are forbidden from the path, once URL-decoded. The reason
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010019832 to such limitation is because otherwise the matching always fails (due to a
19833 limitation one the way regular expression are executed in HAProxy). So if one
19834 of these two characters is found in the URL-decoded path, an error is
19835 returned to the client. The principle of least astonishment is applied here.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019836
19837 Example :
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010019838 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$ # both script-name and path-info may be set
19839 path-info ^(/.+\.php) # the path-info is ignored
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019840
19841option get-values
19842no option get-values
19843 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
19844
19845 HAproxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
19846 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
19847
19848 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
19849 application will accept.
19850
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020019851 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
19852 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019853
19854 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
19855 the connexion immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
19856 option is disabled.
19857
19858 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
19859 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
19860 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
19861 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
19862 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
19863 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
19864
19865option keep-conn
19866no option keep-conn
19867 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
19868 sending a response.
19869
19870 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
19871 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
19872
19873option max-reqs <reqs>
19874 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
19875 accept.
19876
19877 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
19878 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
19879 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
19880 to 1.
19881
19882option mpxs-conns
19883no option mpxs-conns
19884 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
19885
19886 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
19887 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
19888
19889set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
19890 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
19891 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
19892 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
19893 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
19894
19895 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
19896 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
19897 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
19898
19899 Example :
19900 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
19901 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
19902
19903 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
19904
19905
1990610.1.2. Proxy section
19907---------------------
19908
19909use-fcgi-app <name>
19910 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
19911
19912 Arguments :
19913 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
19914
19915 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
19916 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
19917 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
19918 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
19919 application may be defined at a time per backend.
19920
19921 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
19922 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
19923 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
19924 application are evaluated.
19925
19926
1992710.1.3. Example
19928---------------
19929
19930 frontend front-http
19931 mode http
19932 bind *:80
19933 bind *:
19934
19935 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
19936 default_backend back-static
19937
19938 backend back-static
19939 mode http
19940 server www A.B.C.D:80
19941
19942 backend back-dynamic
19943 mode http
19944 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
19945 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
19946
19947 fcgi-app php-fpm
19948 log-stderr global
19949 option keep-conn
19950
19951 docroot /var/www/my-app
19952 index index.php
19953 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
19954
19955
1995610.2. Default parameters
19957------------------------
19958
19959A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
19960the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019961script. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019962applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
19963
19964 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19965 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
19966 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
19967 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
19968 | | |
19969 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19970 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
19971 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
19972 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
19973 | | application. |
19974 | | |
19975 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19976 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
19977 | | the request. It may not be set. |
19978 | | |
19979 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19980 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
19981 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
19982 | | the application's configuration. |
19983 | | |
19984 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19985 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
19986 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
19987 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
19988 | | |
19989 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19990 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
19991 | | following the part that identifies the script |
19992 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
19993 | | be defined. |
19994 | | |
19995 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19996 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
19997 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
19998 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
19999 | | is not set too. |
20000 | | |
20001 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20002 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
20003 | | set. |
20004 | | |
20005 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20006 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
20007 | | the request. |
20008 | | |
20009 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20010 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
20011 | | client as part of user authentication. |
20012 | | |
20013 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20014 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
20015 | | script to process the request. |
20016 | | |
20017 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20018 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
20019 | | |
20020 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20021 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
20022 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
20023 | | |
20024 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20025 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
20026 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
20027 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
20028 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
20029 | | |
20030 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20031 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
20032 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
20033 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
20034 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
20035 | | side. |
20036 | | |
20037 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20038 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
20039 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
20040 | | connected to. |
20041 | | |
20042 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20043 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
20044 | | |
20045 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20046 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
20047 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
20048 | | |
20049 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20050
20051
2005210.3. Limitations
20053------------------
20054
20055The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
20056way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
20057during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
20058establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
20059application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
20060or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
20061message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
20062these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
20063and HTTP servers under the same backend.
20064
20065Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
20066request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
20067requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
20068
20069About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
20070into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
20071fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
20072"http-request" ones.
20073
20074Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
20075FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
20076processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
20077must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
20078here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010020079
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010020080/*
20081 * Local variables:
20082 * fill-column: 79
20083 * End:
20084 */